diff --git a/charts/ingress-controller/Chart.yaml b/charts/ingress-controller/Chart.yaml index 38c804d..d4fd3aa 100644 --- a/charts/ingress-controller/Chart.yaml +++ b/charts/ingress-controller/Chart.yaml @@ -6,7 +6,7 @@ keywords: - api7 - crd type: application -version: 0.1.11 +version: 0.1.12 appVersion: 2.0.6 maintainers: - name: API7 diff --git a/charts/ingress-controller/README.md b/charts/ingress-controller/README.md index 3fc7c47..67f5f90 100644 --- a/charts/ingress-controller/README.md +++ b/charts/ingress-controller/README.md @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ # api7-ingress-controller -![Version: 0.1.11](https://img.shields.io/badge/Version-0.1.11-informational?style=flat-square) ![Type: application](https://img.shields.io/badge/Type-application-informational?style=flat-square) ![AppVersion: 2.0.6](https://img.shields.io/badge/AppVersion-2.0.6-informational?style=flat-square) +![Version: 0.1.12](https://img.shields.io/badge/Version-0.1.12-informational?style=flat-square) ![Type: application](https://img.shields.io/badge/Type-application-informational?style=flat-square) ![AppVersion: 2.0.6](https://img.shields.io/badge/AppVersion-2.0.6-informational?style=flat-square) Ingress Controller for API7 diff --git a/charts/ingress-controller/crds/apisix-crds.yaml b/charts/ingress-controller/crds/apisix-crds.yaml index 3ef155b..20b3e17 100644 --- a/charts/ingress-controller/crds/apisix-crds.yaml +++ b/charts/ingress-controller/crds/apisix-crds.yaml @@ -18,7 +18,8 @@ spec: - name: v2 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: ApisixConsumer is the Schema for the apisixconsumers API. + description: ApisixConsumer defines configuration of a consumer and their + authentication details. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -38,18 +39,18 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: ApisixConsumerSpec defines the desired state of ApisixConsumer. + description: ApisixConsumerSpec defines the consumer authentication configuration. properties: authParameter: + description: AuthParameter defines the authentication credentials + and configuration for this consumer. properties: basicAuth: - description: ApisixConsumerBasicAuth defines the configuration - for basic auth. + description: BasicAuth configures the basic authentication details. properties: secretRef: - description: |- - LocalObjectReference contains enough information to let you locate the - referenced object inside the same namespace. + description: SecretRef references a Kubernetes Secret containing + the basic authentication credentials. properties: name: default: "" @@ -63,12 +64,13 @@ spec: type: object x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic value: - description: ApisixConsumerBasicAuthValue defines the in-place - username and password configuration for basic auth. + description: Value specifies the basic authentication credentials. properties: password: + description: Password is the basic authentication password. type: string username: + description: Username is the basic authentication username. type: string required: - password @@ -76,13 +78,11 @@ spec: type: object type: object hmacAuth: - description: ApisixConsumerHMACAuth defines the configuration - for the hmac auth. + description: HMACAuth configures the HMAC authentication details. properties: secretRef: - description: |- - LocalObjectReference contains enough information to let you locate the - referenced object inside the same namespace. + description: SecretRef references a Kubernetes Secret containing + the HMAC credentials. properties: name: default: "" @@ -96,44 +96,74 @@ spec: type: object x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic value: - description: ApisixConsumerHMACAuthValue defines the in-place - configuration for hmac auth. + description: Value specifies HMAC authentication credentials. + oneOf: + - required: + - key_id + - secret_key + - required: + - access_key + - secret_key properties: access_key: + description: AccessKey is the identifier used to look + up the HMAC secret. Deprecated from consumer configuration type: string algorithm: + description: Algorithm specifies the hashing algorithm + (e.g., "hmac-sha256"). Deprecated from consumer configuration type: string clock_skew: + description: ClockSkew is the allowed time difference + (in seconds) between client and server clocks. Deprecated + from consumer configuration format: int64 type: integer encode_uri_params: + description: EncodeURIParams indicates whether URI parameters + are encoded when calculating the signature. Deprecated + from consumer configuration type: boolean keep_headers: + description: KeepHeaders determines whether the HMAC signature + headers are preserved after verification. Deprecated + from consumer configuration type: boolean + key_id: + description: KeyID is the identifier used to look up the + HMAC secret. + type: string max_req_body: + description: MaxReqBody sets the maximum size (in bytes) + of the request body that can be validated. Deprecated + from consumer configuration format: int64 type: integer secret_key: + description: SecretKey is the HMAC secret used to sign + the request. type: string signed_headers: + description: SignedHeaders lists the headers that must + be included in the signature. Deprecated from consumer + configuration items: type: string type: array validate_request_body: + description: ValidateRequestBody enables HMAC validation + of the request body. Deprecated from consumer configuration type: boolean required: - - access_key - secret_key type: object type: object jwtAuth: - description: ApisixConsumerJwtAuth defines the configuration for - the jwt auth. + description: JwtAuth configures the JWT authentication details. properties: secretRef: - description: |- - LocalObjectReference contains enough information to let you locate the - referenced object inside the same namespace. + description: SecretRef references a Kubernetes Secret containing + JWT authentication credentials. properties: name: default: "" @@ -147,26 +177,42 @@ spec: type: object x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic value: - description: ApisixConsumerJwtAuthValue defines the in-place - configuration for jwt auth. + description: Value specifies JWT authentication credentials. properties: algorithm: + description: |- + Algorithm specifies the signing algorithm. + Can be `HS256`, `HS384`, `HS512`, `RS256`, `RS384`, `RS512`, `ES256`, `ES384`, `ES512`, `PS256`, `PS384`, `PS512`, or `EdDSA`. + Currently APISIX only supports `HS256`, `HS512`, `RS256`, and `ES256`. API7 Enterprise supports all algorithms. type: string base64_secret: + description: Base64Secret indicates whether the secret + is base64-encoded. type: boolean exp: + description: Exp is the token expiration period in seconds. format: int64 type: integer key: + description: Key is the unique identifier for the JWT + credential. type: string lifetime_grace_period: + description: LifetimeGracePeriod is the allowed clock + skew in seconds for token expiration. format: int64 type: integer private_key: + description: PrivateKey is the private key used to sign + the JWT (for asymmetric algorithms). type: string public_key: + description: PublicKey is the public key used to verify + JWT signatures (for asymmetric algorithms). type: string secret: + description: Secret is the shared secret used to sign + the JWT (for symmetric algorithms). type: string required: - key @@ -174,13 +220,11 @@ spec: type: object type: object keyAuth: - description: ApisixConsumerKeyAuth defines the configuration for - the key auth. + description: KeyAuth configures the key authentication details. properties: secretRef: - description: |- - LocalObjectReference contains enough information to let you locate the - referenced object inside the same namespace. + description: SecretRef references a Kubernetes Secret containing + the key authentication credentials. properties: name: default: "" @@ -194,23 +238,21 @@ spec: type: object x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic value: - description: ApisixConsumerKeyAuthValue defines the in-place - configuration for basic auth. + description: Value specifies the key authentication credentials. properties: key: + description: Key is the credential used for key authentication. type: string required: - key type: object type: object ldapAuth: - description: ApisixConsumerLDAPAuth defines the configuration - for the ldap auth. + description: LDAPAuth configures the LDAP authentication details. properties: secretRef: - description: |- - LocalObjectReference contains enough information to let you locate the - referenced object inside the same namespace. + description: SecretRef references a Kubernetes Secret containing + the LDAP credentials. properties: name: default: "" @@ -224,10 +266,11 @@ spec: type: object x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic value: - description: ApisixConsumerLDAPAuthValue defines the in-place - configuration for ldap auth. + description: Value specifies LDAP authentication credentials. properties: user_dn: + description: UserDN is the distinguished name (DN) of + the LDAP user. type: string required: - user_dn @@ -236,13 +279,12 @@ spec: - secretRef type: object wolfRBAC: - description: ApisixConsumerWolfRBAC defines the configuration - for the wolf-rbac auth. + description: WolfRBAC configures the Wolf RBAC authentication + details. properties: secretRef: - description: |- - LocalObjectReference contains enough information to let you locate the - referenced object inside the same namespace. + description: SecretRef references a Kubernetes Secret containing + the Wolf RBAC token. properties: name: default: "" @@ -256,15 +298,18 @@ spec: type: object x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic value: - description: ApisixConsumerWolfRBAC defines the in-place server - and appid and header_prefix configuration for wolf-rbac - auth. + description: Value specifies the Wolf RBAC token. properties: appid: + description: Appid is the application identifier used + when communicating with the Wolf RBAC server. type: string header_prefix: + description: HeaderPrefix is the prefix added to request + headers for RBAC enforcement. type: string server: + description: Server is the URL of the Wolf RBAC server. type: string type: object type: object @@ -272,9 +317,7 @@ spec: ingressClassName: description: |- IngressClassName is the name of an IngressClass cluster resource. - controller implementations use this field to know whether they should be - serving this ApisixConsumer resource, by a transitive connection - (controller -> IngressClass -> ApisixConsumer resource). + The controller uses this field to decide whether the resource should be managed. type: string required: - authParameter @@ -365,7 +408,7 @@ spec: - name: v2 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: ApisixGlobalRule is the Schema for the apisixglobalrules API. + description: ApisixGlobalRule defines configuration for global plugins. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -385,15 +428,15 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: ApisixGlobalRuleSpec defines the desired state of ApisixGlobalRule. + description: ApisixGlobalRuleSpec defines the global plugin configuration. properties: ingressClassName: description: |- IngressClassName is the name of an IngressClass cluster resource. - The controller uses this field to decide whether the resource should be managed or not. + The controller uses this field to decide whether the resource should be managed. type: string plugins: - description: Plugins contains a list of ApisixRoutePlugin + description: Plugins contain a list of global plugins. items: description: ApisixRoutePlugin represents an APISIX plugin. properties: @@ -504,8 +547,8 @@ spec: - name: v2 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: ApisixPluginConfig is the Schema for the apisixpluginconfigs - API. + description: ApisixPluginConfig defines a reusable set of plugin configuration + that can be referenced by routes. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -525,15 +568,15 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: ApisixPluginConfigSpec defines the desired state of ApisixPluginConfigSpec. + description: ApisixPluginConfigSpec defines the plugin config configuration. properties: ingressClassName: description: |- IngressClassName is the name of an IngressClass cluster resource. - The controller uses this field to decide whether the resource should be managed or not. + The controller uses this field to decide whether the resource should be managed. type: string plugins: - description: Plugins contain a list of ApisixRoutePlugin + description: Plugins contain a list of plugins. items: description: ApisixRoutePlugin represents an APISIX plugin. properties: @@ -672,7 +715,7 @@ spec: name: v2 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: ApisixRoute is the Schema for the apisixroutes API. + description: ApisixRoute is defines configuration for HTTP and stream routes. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -692,55 +735,67 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: ApisixRouteSpec is the spec definition for ApisixRouteSpec. + description: ApisixRouteSpec defines HTTP and stream route configuration. properties: http: + description: |- + HTTP defines a list of HTTP route rules. + Each rule specifies conditions to match HTTP requests and how to forward them. items: - description: ApisixRouteHTTP represents a single route in for HTTP - traffic. + description: ApisixRouteHTTP represents a single HTTP route configuration. properties: authentication: - description: |- - ApisixRouteAuthentication is the authentication-related - configuration in ApisixRoute. + description: Authentication holds authentication-related configuration + for this route. properties: enable: + description: Enable toggles authentication on or off. type: boolean jwtAuth: - description: |- - ApisixRouteAuthenticationJwtAuth is the jwt auth related - configuration in ApisixRouteAuthentication. + description: JwtAuth defines configuration for JWT authentication. properties: cookie: + description: Cookie specifies the cookie name to look + for the JWT token. type: string header: + description: Header specifies the HTTP header name to + look for the JWT token. type: string query: + description: Query specifies the URL query parameter + name to look for the JWT token. type: string type: object keyAuth: - description: |- - ApisixRouteAuthenticationKeyAuth is the keyAuth-related - configuration in ApisixRouteAuthentication. + description: KeyAuth defines configuration for key authentication. properties: header: + description: Header specifies the HTTP header name to + look for the key authentication token. type: string type: object ldapAuth: - description: |- - ApisixRouteAuthenticationLDAPAuth is the LDAP auth related - configuration in ApisixRouteAuthentication. + description: LDAPAuth defines configuration for LDAP authentication. properties: base_dn: + description: BaseDN is the base distinguished name (DN) + for LDAP searches. type: string ldap_uri: + description: LDAPURI is the URI of the LDAP server. type: string uid: + description: UID is the user identifier attribute in + LDAP. type: string use_tls: + description: UseTLS indicates whether to use TLS for + the LDAP connection. type: boolean type: object type: + description: Type specifies the authentication type. type: string required: - enable @@ -748,39 +803,42 @@ spec: type: object backends: description: |- - Backends represents potential backends to proxy after the route - rule matched. When number of backends are more than one, traffic-split - plugin in APISIX will be used to split traffic based on the backend weight. + Backends lists potential backend services to proxy requests to. + If more than one backend is specified, the `traffic-split` plugin is used + to distribute traffic according to backend weights. items: description: ApisixRouteHTTPBackend represents an HTTP backend - (a Kubernetes Service). + (Kubernetes Service). properties: resolveGranularity: description: |- - The resolve granularity, can be "endpoints" or "service", - when set to "endpoints", the pod ips will be used; other - wise, the service ClusterIP or ExternalIP will be used, - default is endpoints. + ResolveGranularity determines how the backend service is resolved. + Valid values are `endpoints` and `service`. When set to `endpoints`, + individual pod IPs will be used; otherwise, the Service's ClusterIP or ExternalIP is used. + The default is `endpoints`. type: string serviceName: description: |- - The name (short) of the service, note cross namespace is forbidden, - so be sure the ApisixRoute and Service are in the same namespace. + ServiceName is the name of the Kubernetes Service. + Cross-namespace references are not supported—ensure the ApisixRoute + and the Service are in the same namespace. type: string servicePort: anyOf: - type: integer - type: string - description: The service port, could be the name or the - port number. + description: |- + ServicePort is the port of the Kubernetes Service. + This can be either the port name or port number. x-kubernetes-int-or-string: true subset: description: |- - Subset specifies a subset for the target Service. The subset should be pre-defined - in ApisixUpstream about this service. + Subset specifies a named subset of the target Service. + The subset must be pre-defined in the corresponding ApisixUpstream resource. type: string weight: - description: Weight of this backend. + description: Weight specifies the relative traffic weight + for this backend. type: integer required: - serviceName @@ -788,51 +846,41 @@ spec: type: object type: array match: - description: ApisixRouteHTTPMatch represents the match condition - for hitting this route. + description: Match defines the HTTP request matching criteria. properties: exprs: - description: |- - NginxVars represents generic match predicates, - it uses Nginx variable systems, so any predicate - like headers, querystring and etc can be leveraged - here to match the route. - For instance, it can be: - nginxVars: - - subject: "$remote_addr" - op: in - value: - - "127.0.0.1" - - "10.0.5.11" + description: NginxVars defines match conditions based on + Nginx variables. items: description: ApisixRouteHTTPMatchExpr represents a binary - route match expression . + expression used to match requests based on Nginx variables. properties: op: - description: Op is the operator. + description: |- + Op specifies the operator used in the expression. + Can be `Equal`, `NotEqual`, `GreaterThan`, `GreaterThanEqual`, `LessThan`, `LessThanEqual`, `RegexMatch`, + `RegexNotMatch`, `RegexMatchCaseInsensitive`, `RegexNotMatchCaseInsensitive`, `In`, or `NotIn`. type: string set: description: |- - Set is an array type object of the expression. - It should be used when the Op is "in" or "not_in"; + Set provides a list of acceptable values for the expression. + This should be used when Op is `In` or `NotIn`. items: type: string type: array subject: description: |- - Subject is the expression subject, it can - be any string composed by literals and nginx - vars. + Subject defines the left-hand side of the expression. + It can be any [built-in variable](/apisix/reference/built-in-variables) or string literal. properties: name: - description: The name of subject. + description: Name is the name of the header or + query parameter. type: string scope: description: |- - The subject scope, can be: - ScopeQuery, ScopeHeader, ScopePath - when subject is ScopePath, Name field - will be ignored. + Scope specifies the subject scope and can be `Header`, `Query`, or `Path`. + When Scope is `Path`, Name will be ignored. type: string required: - name @@ -840,10 +888,9 @@ spec: type: object value: description: |- - Value is the normal type object for the expression, - it should be used when the Op is not "in" and "not_in". - Set and Value are exclusive so only of them can be set - in the same time. + Value defines a single value to compare against the subject. + This should be used when Op is not `In` or `NotIn`. + Set and Value are mutually exclusive—only one should be set at a time. type: string required: - op @@ -852,36 +899,37 @@ spec: type: array filter_func: description: |- - Matches based on a user-defined filtering function. - These functions can accept an input parameter `vars` - which can be used to access the Nginx variables. + FilterFunc is a user-defined function for advanced request filtering. + The function can use Nginx variables through the `vars` parameter. + This field is supported in APISIX but not in API7 Enterprise. type: string hosts: description: |- - HTTP Host predicates, host can be a wildcard domain or - an exact domain. For wildcard domain, only one generic - level is allowed, for instance, "*.foo.com" is valid but - "*.*.foo.com" is not. + Hosts specifies Host header values to match. + Supports exact and wildcard domains. + Only one level of wildcard is allowed (e.g., `*.example.com` is valid, + but `*.*.example.com` is not). items: type: string type: array methods: - description: HTTP request method predicates. + description: Methods specifies the HTTP methods to match. items: type: string type: array paths: description: |- - URI path predicates, at least one path should be - configured, path could be exact or prefix, for prefix path, - append "*" after it, for instance, "/foo*". + Paths is a list of URI path patterns to match. + At least one path must be specified. + Supports exact matches and prefix matches. + For prefix matches, append `*` to the path, such as `/foo*`. items: type: string type: array remoteAddrs: description: |- - Remote address predicates, items can be valid IPv4 address - or IPv6 address or CIDR. + RemoteAddrs is a list of source IP addresses or CIDR ranges to match. + Supports both IPv4 and IPv6 formats. items: type: string type: array @@ -889,15 +937,20 @@ spec: - paths type: object name: - description: The rule name, cannot be empty. + description: Name is the unique rule name and cannot be empty. type: string plugin_config_name: + description: PluginConfigName specifies the name of the plugin + config to apply. type: string plugin_config_namespace: - description: By default, PluginConfigNamespace will be the same - as the namespace of ApisixRoute + description: |- + PluginConfigNamespace specifies the namespace of the plugin config. + Defaults to the namespace of the ApisixRoute if not set. type: string plugins: + description: Plugins lists additional plugins applied to this + route. items: description: ApisixRoutePlugin represents an APISIX plugin. properties: @@ -922,97 +975,123 @@ spec: type: array priority: description: |- - Route priority, when multiple routes contains - same URI path (for path matching), route with - higher priority will take effect. + Priority defines the route priority when multiple routes share the same URI path. + Higher values mean higher priority in route matching. type: integer timeout: - description: UpstreamTimeout is settings for the read, send - and connect to the upstream. + description: Timeout specifies upstream timeout settings. properties: connect: + description: Connect timeout for establishing a connection + to the upstream. type: string read: + description: Read timeout for reading data from the upstream. type: string send: + description: Send timeout for sending data to the upstream. type: string type: object upstreams: - description: Upstreams refer to ApisixUpstream CRD + description: Upstreams references ApisixUpstream CRDs. items: - description: ApisixRouteUpstreamReference contains a ApisixUpstream - CRD reference + description: |- + ApisixRouteUpstreamReference references an ApisixUpstream CRD to be used as a backend. + It can be used in traffic-splitting scenarios or to select a specific upstream configuration. properties: name: + description: Name is the name of the ApisixUpstream resource. type: string weight: + description: Weight is the weight assigned to this upstream. type: integer type: object type: array websocket: + description: Websocket enables or disables websocket support + for this route. type: boolean required: - name type: object type: array ingressClassName: + description: |- + IngressClassName is the name of the IngressClass this route belongs to. + It allows multiple controllers to watch and reconcile different routes. type: string stream: + description: |- + Stream defines a list of stream route rules. + Each rule specifies conditions to match TCP/UDP traffic and how to forward them. items: - description: ApisixRouteStream is the configuration for level 4 - route + description: ApisixRouteStream defines the configuration for a Layer + 4 (TCP/UDP) route. Currently not supported. properties: backend: - description: ApisixRouteStreamBackend represents a TCP backend - (a Kubernetes Service). + description: Backend specifies the destination service to which + traffic should be forwarded. properties: resolveGranularity: + default: endpoint description: |- - The resolve granularity, can be "endpoints" or "service", - when set to "endpoints", the pod ips will be used; other - wise, the service ClusterIP or ExternalIP will be used, - default is endpoints. + ResolveGranularity determines how the backend service is resolved. + Valid values are `endpoint` and `service`. When set to `endpoint`, + individual pod IPs will be used; otherwise, the Service's ClusterIP or ExternalIP is used. + The default is `endpoint`. + enum: + - endpoint + - service type: string serviceName: description: |- - The name (short) of the service, note cross namespace is forbidden, - so be sure the ApisixRoute and Service are in the same namespace. + ServiceName is the name of the Kubernetes Service. + Cross-namespace references are not supported—ensure the ApisixRoute + and the Service are in the same namespace. type: string servicePort: anyOf: - type: integer - type: string - description: The service port, could be the name or the - port number. + description: |- + ServicePort is the port of the Kubernetes Service. + This can be either the port name or port number. x-kubernetes-int-or-string: true subset: description: |- - Subset specifies a subset for the target Service. The subset should be pre-defined - in ApisixUpstream about this service. + Subset specifies a named subset of the target Service. + The subset must be pre-defined in the corresponding ApisixUpstream resource. type: string required: - serviceName - servicePort type: object match: - description: ApisixRouteStreamMatch represents the match conditions - of stream route. + description: Match defines the criteria used to match incoming + TCP or UDP connections. properties: host: + description: Host is the destination host address used to + match the incoming TCP/UDP traffic. type: string ingressPort: description: |- - IngressPort represents the port listening on the Ingress proxy server. - It should be pre-defined as APISIX doesn't support dynamic listening. + IngressPort is the port on which the APISIX Ingress proxy server listens. + This must be a statically configured port, as APISIX does not support dynamic port binding. format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 0 type: integer required: - ingressPort type: object name: - description: The rule name cannot be empty. + description: Name is a unique identifier for the route. This + field must not be empty. type: string plugins: + description: Plugins defines a list of plugins to apply to this + route. items: description: ApisixRoutePlugin represents an APISIX plugin. properties: @@ -1036,6 +1115,11 @@ spec: type: object type: array protocol: + description: Protocol specifies the L4 protocol to match. Can + be `TCP` or `UDP`. + enum: + - TCP + - UDP type: string required: - backend @@ -1150,7 +1234,7 @@ spec: name: v2 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: ApisixTls is the Schema for the apisixtls API. + description: ApisixTls defines configuration for TLS and mutual TLS (mTLS). properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -1170,20 +1254,23 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: ApisixTlsSpec defines the desired state of ApisixTls. + description: ApisixTlsSpec defines the TLS configuration. properties: client: - description: ApisixMutualTlsClientConfig describes the mutual TLS - CA and verify depth + description: Client defines mutual TLS (mTLS) settings, such as the + CA certificate and verification depth. properties: caSecret: - description: ApisixSecret describes the Kubernetes Secret name - and namespace. + description: CASecret references the secret containing the CA + certificate for client certificate validation. properties: name: + description: Name is the name of the Kubernetes Secret. minLength: 1 type: string namespace: + description: Namespace is the namespace where the Kubernetes + Secret is located. minLength: 1 type: string required: @@ -1191,13 +1278,20 @@ spec: - namespace type: object depth: + description: Depth specifies the maximum verification depth for + the client certificate chain. type: integer skip_mtls_uri_regex: + description: SkipMTLSUriRegex contains RegEx patterns for URIs + to skip mutual TLS verification. items: type: string type: array type: object hosts: + description: |- + Hosts lists the SNI (Server Name Indication) hostnames that this TLS configuration applies to. + Must contain at least one host. items: pattern: ^\*?[0-9a-zA-Z-.]+$ type: string @@ -1205,19 +1299,21 @@ spec: type: array ingressClassName: description: |- - IngressClassName is the name of an IngressClass cluster resource. - controller implementations use this field to know whether they should be - serving this ApisixTls resource, by a transitive connection - (controller -> IngressClass -> ApisixTls resource). + IngressClassName specifies which IngressClass this resource is associated with. + The APISIX controller only processes this resource if the class matches its own. type: string secret: - description: ApisixSecret describes the Kubernetes Secret name and - namespace. + description: |- + Secret refers to the Kubernetes TLS secret containing the certificate and private key. + This secret must exist in the specified namespace and contain valid TLS data. properties: name: + description: Name is the name of the Kubernetes Secret. minLength: 1 type: string namespace: + description: Namespace is the namespace where the Kubernetes Secret + is located. minLength: 1 type: string required: @@ -1314,7 +1410,7 @@ spec: - name: v2 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: ApisixUpstream is the Schema for the apisixupstreams API. + description: ApisixUpstream defines configuration for upstream services. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -1334,20 +1430,25 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: ApisixUpstreamSpec describes the specification of ApisixUpstream. + description: ApisixUpstreamSpec defines the upstream configuration. properties: discovery: description: |- - Deprecated: this is no longer support on standalone mode. - Discovery is used to configure service discovery for upstream. + Discovery configures service discovery for the upstream. + Deprecated: no longer supported in standalone mode. properties: args: additionalProperties: type: string + description: |- + Args contains additional configuration parameters required by the discovery provider. + These are passed as key-value pairs. type: object serviceName: + description: ServiceName is the name of the service to discover. type: string type: + description: Type is the name of the service discovery provider. type: string required: - serviceName @@ -1355,147 +1456,187 @@ spec: type: object externalNodes: description: |- - ExternalNodes contains external nodes the Upstream should use - If this field is set, the upstream will use these nodes directly without any further resolves + ExternalNodes defines a static list of backend nodes. These can be external hosts + outside the cluster or cluster-internal Services specified by their DNS name. + When this field is set, the upstream will route traffic directly to these nodes + without DNS resolution or service discovery. items: - description: ApisixUpstreamExternalNode is the external node conf + description: |- + ApisixUpstreamExternalNode defines configuration for an external upstream node. + This allows referencing services outside the cluster. properties: name: + description: Name is the hostname or IP address of the external + node. type: string port: - description: Port defines the port of the external node + description: Port specifies the port number on which the external + node is accepting traffic. type: integer type: - description: ApisixUpstreamExternalType is the external service - type + description: Type indicates the kind of external node. Can be + `Domain`, or `Service`. type: string weight: + description: |- + Weight defines the load balancing weight of this node. + Higher values increase the share of traffic sent to this node. type: integer type: object minItems: 1 type: array healthCheck: description: |- - Deprecated: this is no longer support on standalone mode. - The health check configurations for the upstream. + HealthCheck defines the active and passive health check configuration for the upstream. + Deprecated: no longer supported in standalone mode. properties: active: - description: ActiveHealthCheck defines the active kind of upstream - health check. + description: Active health checks proactively send requests to + upstream nodes to determine their availability. properties: concurrency: + description: Concurrency sets the number of targets to be + checked at the same time. minimum: 0 type: integer healthy: - description: |- - ActiveHealthCheckHealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is healthy with the active manner. + description: Healthy configures the rules that define an upstream + node as healthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status codes + that are considered healthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array interval: + description: Interval defines the time interval for checking + targets, in seconds. type: string successes: + description: Successes define the number of successful + probes to define a healthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer type: object host: + description: Host sets the upstream host. type: string httpPath: + description: HTTPPath sets the HTTP probe request path. type: string port: + description: Port sets the upstream port. format: int32 maximum: 65535 minimum: 0 type: integer requestHeaders: + description: RequestHeaders sets the request headers. items: type: string type: array strictTLS: + description: StrictTLS sets whether to enforce TLS. type: boolean timeout: - description: |- - A Duration represents the elapsed time between two instants - as an int64 nanosecond count. The representation limits the - largest representable duration to approximately 290 years. + description: Timeout sets health check timeout in seconds. format: int64 type: integer type: + description: Type is the health check type. Can be `http`, + `https`, or `tcp`. enum: - http - https - tcp type: string unhealthy: - description: |- - ActiveHealthCheckUnhealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is unhealthy with the active manager. + description: Unhealthy configures the rules that define an + upstream node as unhealthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status codes + that are considered unhealthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array httpFailures: + description: HTTPFailures define the number of HTTP failures + to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer interval: + description: Interval defines the time interval for checking + targets, in seconds. type: string tcpFailures: + description: TCPFailures define the number of TCP failures + to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer timeout: + description: Timeout sets health check timeout in seconds. type: integer type: object type: object passive: - description: |- - PassiveHealthCheck defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is healthy with the passive manager. + description: Passive health checks evaluate upstream health based + on observed traffic, such as timeouts or errors. properties: healthy: - description: |- - PassiveHealthCheckHealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is healthy with the passive manner. + description: Healthy defines the conditions under which an + upstream node is considered healthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status codes + that are considered healthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array successes: + description: Successes define the number of successful + probes to define a healthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer type: object type: + description: |- + Type specifies the type of passive health check. + Can be `http`, `https`, or `tcp`. type: string unhealthy: - description: |- - PassiveHealthCheckUnhealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is unhealthy with the passive manager. + description: Unhealthy defines the conditions under which + an upstream node is considered unhealthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status codes + that are considered unhealthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array httpFailures: + description: HTTPFailures define the number of HTTP failures + to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer tcpFailures: + description: TCPFailures define the number of TCP failures + to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer timeout: + description: Timeout sets health check timeout in seconds. type: integer type: object type: object @@ -1505,56 +1646,89 @@ spec: ingressClassName: description: |- IngressClassName is the name of an IngressClass cluster resource. - controller implementations use this field to know whether they should be - serving this ApisixUpstream resource, by a transitive connection - (controller -> IngressClass -> ApisixUpstream resource). + Controller implementations use this field to determine whether they + should process this ApisixUpstream resource. type: string loadbalancer: - description: |- - LoadBalancer represents the load balancer configuration for Kubernetes Service. - The default strategy is round robin. + description: LoadBalancer specifies the load balancer configuration + for Kubernetes Service. properties: hashOn: + default: vars description: |- - The HashOn and Key fields are required when Type is "chash". - HashOn represents the key fetching scope. + HashOn specified the type of field used for hashing, required when type is `chash`. + Default is `vars`. Can be `vars`, `header`, `cookie`, `consumer`, or `vars_combinations`. + enum: + - vars + - header + - cookie + - consumer + - vars_combinations type: string key: - description: Key represents the hash key. + description: |- + Key is used with HashOn, generally required when type is `chash`. + When HashOn is `header` or `cookie`, specifies the name of the header or cookie. + When HashOn is `consumer`, key is not required, as the consumer name is used automatically. + When HashOn is `vars` or `vars_combinations`, key refers to one or a combination of + [built-in variables](/enterprise/reference/built-in-variables). type: string type: + default: roundrobin + description: |- + Type specifies the load balancing algorithms to route traffic to the backend. + Default is `roundrobin`. + Can be `roundrobin`, `chash`, `ewma`, or `least_conn`. + enum: + - roundrobin + - chash + - ewma + - least_conn type: string required: - type type: object passHost: description: |- - Configures the host when the request is forwarded to the upstream. - Can be one of pass, node or rewrite. + PassHost configures how the host header should be determined when a + request is forwarded to the upstream. + Default is `pass`. + Can be `pass`, `node` or `rewrite`: + * `pass`: preserve the original Host header + * `node`: use the upstream node’s host + * `rewrite`: set to a custom host via upstreamHost enum: - pass - node - rewrite type: string portLevelSettings: + description: |- + PortLevelSettings allows fine-grained upstream configuration for specific ports, + useful when a backend service exposes multiple ports with different behaviors or protocols. items: description: |- PortLevelSettings configures the ApisixUpstreamConfig for each individual port. It inherits - configurations from the outer level (the whole Kubernetes Service) and overrides some of + configuration from the outer level (the whole Kubernetes Service) and overrides some of them if they are set on the port level. properties: discovery: description: |- - Deprecated: this is no longer support on standalone mode. - Discovery is used to configure service discovery for upstream. + Discovery configures service discovery for the upstream. + Deprecated: no longer supported in standalone mode. properties: args: additionalProperties: type: string + description: |- + Args contains additional configuration parameters required by the discovery provider. + These are passed as key-value pairs. type: object serviceName: + description: ServiceName is the name of the service to discover. type: string type: + description: Type is the name of the service discovery provider. type: string required: - serviceName @@ -1562,126 +1736,158 @@ spec: type: object healthCheck: description: |- - Deprecated: this is no longer support on standalone mode. - The health check configurations for the upstream. + HealthCheck defines the active and passive health check configuration for the upstream. + Deprecated: no longer supported in standalone mode. properties: active: - description: ActiveHealthCheck defines the active kind of - upstream health check. + description: Active health checks proactively send requests + to upstream nodes to determine their availability. properties: concurrency: + description: Concurrency sets the number of targets + to be checked at the same time. minimum: 0 type: integer healthy: - description: |- - ActiveHealthCheckHealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is healthy with the active manner. + description: Healthy configures the rules that define + an upstream node as healthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status + codes that are considered healthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array interval: + description: Interval defines the time interval + for checking targets, in seconds. type: string successes: + description: Successes define the number of successful + probes to define a healthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer type: object host: + description: Host sets the upstream host. type: string httpPath: + description: HTTPPath sets the HTTP probe request path. type: string port: + description: Port sets the upstream port. format: int32 maximum: 65535 minimum: 0 type: integer requestHeaders: + description: RequestHeaders sets the request headers. items: type: string type: array strictTLS: + description: StrictTLS sets whether to enforce TLS. type: boolean timeout: - description: |- - A Duration represents the elapsed time between two instants - as an int64 nanosecond count. The representation limits the - largest representable duration to approximately 290 years. + description: Timeout sets health check timeout in seconds. format: int64 type: integer type: + description: Type is the health check type. Can be `http`, + `https`, or `tcp`. enum: - http - https - tcp type: string unhealthy: - description: |- - ActiveHealthCheckUnhealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is unhealthy with the active manager. + description: Unhealthy configures the rules that define + an upstream node as unhealthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status + codes that are considered unhealthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array httpFailures: + description: HTTPFailures define the number of HTTP + failures to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer interval: + description: Interval defines the time interval + for checking targets, in seconds. type: string tcpFailures: + description: TCPFailures define the number of TCP + failures to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer timeout: + description: Timeout sets health check timeout in + seconds. type: integer type: object type: object passive: - description: |- - PassiveHealthCheck defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is healthy with the passive manager. + description: Passive health checks evaluate upstream health + based on observed traffic, such as timeouts or errors. properties: healthy: - description: |- - PassiveHealthCheckHealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is healthy with the passive manner. + description: Healthy defines the conditions under which + an upstream node is considered healthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status + codes that are considered healthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array successes: + description: Successes define the number of successful + probes to define a healthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer type: object type: + description: |- + Type specifies the type of passive health check. + Can be `http`, `https`, or `tcp`. type: string unhealthy: - description: |- - PassiveHealthCheckUnhealthy defines the conditions to judge whether - an upstream node is unhealthy with the passive manager. + description: Unhealthy defines the conditions under + which an upstream node is considered unhealthy. properties: httpCodes: + description: HTTPCodes define a list of HTTP status + codes that are considered unhealthy. items: type: integer minItems: 1 type: array httpFailures: + description: HTTPFailures define the number of HTTP + failures to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer tcpFailures: + description: TCPFailures define the number of TCP + failures to define an unhealthy target. maximum: 254 minimum: 0 type: integer timeout: + description: Timeout sets health check timeout in + seconds. type: integer type: object type: object @@ -1689,47 +1895,73 @@ spec: - active type: object loadbalancer: - description: |- - LoadBalancer represents the load balancer configuration for Kubernetes Service. - The default strategy is round robin. + description: LoadBalancer specifies the load balancer configuration + for Kubernetes Service. properties: hashOn: + default: vars description: |- - The HashOn and Key fields are required when Type is "chash". - HashOn represents the key fetching scope. + HashOn specified the type of field used for hashing, required when type is `chash`. + Default is `vars`. Can be `vars`, `header`, `cookie`, `consumer`, or `vars_combinations`. + enum: + - vars + - header + - cookie + - consumer + - vars_combinations type: string key: - description: Key represents the hash key. + description: |- + Key is used with HashOn, generally required when type is `chash`. + When HashOn is `header` or `cookie`, specifies the name of the header or cookie. + When HashOn is `consumer`, key is not required, as the consumer name is used automatically. + When HashOn is `vars` or `vars_combinations`, key refers to one or a combination of + [built-in variables](/enterprise/reference/built-in-variables). type: string type: + default: roundrobin + description: |- + Type specifies the load balancing algorithms to route traffic to the backend. + Default is `roundrobin`. + Can be `roundrobin`, `chash`, `ewma`, or `least_conn`. + enum: + - roundrobin + - chash + - ewma + - least_conn type: string required: - type type: object passHost: description: |- - Configures the host when the request is forwarded to the upstream. - Can be one of pass, node or rewrite. + PassHost configures how the host header should be determined when a + request is forwarded to the upstream. + Default is `pass`. + Can be `pass`, `node` or `rewrite`: + * `pass`: preserve the original Host header + * `node`: use the upstream node’s host + * `rewrite`: set to a custom host via upstreamHost enum: - pass - node - rewrite type: string port: - description: Port is a Kubernetes Service port, it should be - already defined. + description: Port is a Kubernetes Service port. format: int32 type: integer retries: description: |- - How many times that the proxy (Apache APISIX) should do when - errors occur (error, timeout or bad http status codes like 500, 502). + Retries defines the number of retry attempts APISIX should make when a failure occurs. + Failures include timeouts, network errors, or 5xx status codes. format: int64 type: integer scheme: description: |- - The scheme used to talk with the upstream. - Now value can be http, grpc. + Scheme is the protocol used to communicate with the upstream. + Default is `http`. + Can be `http`, `https`, `grpc`, or `grpcs`. enum: - http - https @@ -1738,8 +1970,8 @@ spec: type: string subsets: description: |- - Subsets groups the service endpoints by their labels. Usually used to differentiate - service versions. + Subsets defines labeled subsets of service endpoints, typically used for + service versioning or canary deployments. items: description: ApisixUpstreamSubset defines a single endpoints group of one Service. @@ -1758,24 +1990,32 @@ spec: type: object type: array timeout: - description: Timeout settings for the read, send and connect - to the upstream. + description: Timeout specifies the connection, send, and read + timeouts for upstream requests. properties: connect: + description: Connect timeout for establishing a connection + to the upstream. type: string read: + description: Read timeout for reading data from the upstream. type: string send: + description: Send timeout for sending data to the upstream. type: string type: object tlsSecret: - description: Set the client certificate when connecting to TLS - upstream. + description: |- + TLSSecret references a Kubernetes Secret that contains the client certificate and key + for mutual TLS when connecting to the upstream. properties: name: + description: Name is the name of the Kubernetes Secret. minLength: 1 type: string namespace: + description: Namespace is the namespace where the Kubernetes + Secret is located. minLength: 1 type: string required: @@ -1783,9 +2023,8 @@ spec: - namespace type: object upstreamHost: - description: |- - Specifies the host of the Upstream request. This is only valid if - the pass_host is set to rewrite + description: UpstreamHost sets a custom Host header when passHost + is set to `rewrite`. type: string required: - port @@ -1793,14 +2032,15 @@ spec: type: array retries: description: |- - How many times that the proxy (Apache APISIX) should do when - errors occur (error, timeout or bad http status codes like 500, 502). + Retries defines the number of retry attempts APISIX should make when a failure occurs. + Failures include timeouts, network errors, or 5xx status codes. format: int64 type: integer scheme: description: |- - The scheme used to talk with the upstream. - Now value can be http, grpc. + Scheme is the protocol used to communicate with the upstream. + Default is `http`. + Can be `http`, `https`, `grpc`, or `grpcs`. enum: - http - https @@ -1809,8 +2049,8 @@ spec: type: string subsets: description: |- - Subsets groups the service endpoints by their labels. Usually used to differentiate - service versions. + Subsets defines labeled subsets of service endpoints, typically used for + service versioning or canary deployments. items: description: ApisixUpstreamSubset defines a single endpoints group of one Service. @@ -1829,23 +2069,32 @@ spec: type: object type: array timeout: - description: Timeout settings for the read, send and connect to the - upstream. + description: Timeout specifies the connection, send, and read timeouts + for upstream requests. properties: connect: + description: Connect timeout for establishing a connection to + the upstream. type: string read: + description: Read timeout for reading data from the upstream. type: string send: + description: Send timeout for sending data to the upstream. type: string type: object tlsSecret: - description: Set the client certificate when connecting to TLS upstream. + description: |- + TLSSecret references a Kubernetes Secret that contains the client certificate and key + for mutual TLS when connecting to the upstream. properties: name: + description: Name is the name of the Kubernetes Secret. minLength: 1 type: string namespace: + description: Namespace is the namespace where the Kubernetes Secret + is located. minLength: 1 type: string required: @@ -1853,9 +2102,8 @@ spec: - namespace type: object upstreamHost: - description: |- - Specifies the host of the Upstream request. This is only valid if - the pass_host is set to rewrite + description: UpstreamHost sets a custom Host header when passHost + is set to `rewrite`. type: string type: object status: @@ -1942,6 +2190,8 @@ spec: - name: v1alpha1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: + description: BackendTrafficPolicy defines configuration for traffic handling + policies applied to backend services. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -1973,9 +2223,9 @@ spec: hashOn: default: vars description: |- - HashOn specified the type of field used for hashing, required when Type is `chash`. + HashOn specified the type of field used for hashing, required when type is `chash`. Default is `vars`. - Can be one of `vars`, `header`, `cookie`, `consumer`, or `vars_combinations`. + Can be `vars`, `header`, `cookie`, `consumer`, or `vars_combinations`. enum: - vars - header @@ -1985,18 +2235,18 @@ spec: type: string key: description: |- - Key is used with HashOn, generally required when Type is `chash`. + Key is used with HashOn, generally required when type is `chash`. When HashOn is `header` or `cookie`, specifies the name of the header or cookie. When HashOn is `consumer`, key is not required, as the consumer name is used automatically. When HashOn is `vars` or `vars_combinations`, key refers to one or a combination of - [APISIX variable](https://apisix.apache.org/docs/apisix/apisix-variable/). + [built-in variables](/enterprise/reference/built-in-variables). type: string type: default: roundrobin description: |- - Type specifies the load balancing algorithms. + Type specifies the load balancing algorithms to route traffic to the backend. Default is `roundrobin`. - Can be one of `roundrobin`, `chash`, `ewma`, or `least_conn`. + Can be `roundrobin`, `chash`, `ewma`, or `least_conn`. enum: - roundrobin - chash @@ -2013,8 +2263,10 @@ spec: description: |- PassHost configures how the host header should be determined when a request is forwarded to the upstream. - Default is `pass`. - Can be one of `pass`, `node` or `rewrite`. + Default is `pass`. Can be `pass`, `node` or `rewrite`: + * `pass`: preserve the original Host header + * `node`: use the upstream node’s host + * `rewrite`: set to a custom host via `upstreamHost` enum: - pass - node @@ -2030,7 +2282,7 @@ spec: description: |- Scheme is the protocol used to communicate with the upstream. Default is `http`. - Can be one of `http`, `https`, `grpc`, or `grpcs`. + Can be `http`, `https`, `grpc`, or `grpcs`. enum: - http - https @@ -2451,6 +2703,7 @@ spec: - name: v1alpha1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: + description: Consumer defines configuration for a consumer. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -2471,7 +2724,7 @@ spec: type: object spec: description: |- - ConsumerSpec defines the configuration for a consumer, including consumer name, + ConsumerSpec defines configuration for a consumer, including consumer name, authentication credentials, and plugin settings. properties: credentials: @@ -2505,7 +2758,7 @@ spec: type: description: |- Type specifies the type of authentication to configure credentials for. - Can be one of `jwt-auth`, `basic-auth`, `key-auth`, or `hmac-auth`. + Can be `jwt-auth`, `basic-auth`, `key-auth`, or `hmac-auth`. enum: - jwt-auth - basic-auth @@ -2637,7 +2890,8 @@ spec: - name: v1alpha1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: GatewayProxy is the Schema for the gatewayproxies API. + description: GatewayProxy defines configuration for the gateway proxy instances + used to route traffic to services. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -2658,19 +2912,19 @@ spec: type: object spec: description: |- - GatewayProxySpec defines the desired state and configuration of a GatewayProxy, + GatewayProxySpec defines configuration of gateway proxy instances, including networking settings, global plugins, and plugin metadata. properties: pluginMetadata: additionalProperties: x-kubernetes-preserve-unknown-fields: true - description: PluginMetadata configures common configurations shared + description: PluginMetadata configures common configuration shared by all plugin instances of the same name. type: object plugins: description: Plugins configure global plugins. items: - description: GatewayProxyPlugin contains plugin configurations. + description: GatewayProxyPlugin contains plugin configuration. properties: config: description: Config defines the plugin's configuration details. @@ -2691,7 +2945,7 @@ spec: plane provider. properties: auth: - description: Auth specifies the authentication configurations. + description: Auth specifies the authentication configuration. properties: adminKey: description: AdminKey specifies the admin key authentication @@ -2742,8 +2996,10 @@ spec: service: properties: name: + description: Name is the name of the provider. type: string port: + description: Port is the port of the provider. format: int32 maximum: 65535 minimum: 1 @@ -2808,7 +3064,7 @@ spec: - name: v1alpha1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: HTTPRoutePolicy is the Schema for the httproutepolicies API. + description: HTTPRoutePolicy defines configuration of traffic policies. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -2829,12 +3085,13 @@ spec: type: object spec: description: |- - HTTPRoutePolicySpec defines the desired state and configuration of a HTTPRoutePolicy, + HTTPRoutePolicySpec defines configuration of a HTTPRoutePolicy, including route priority and request matching conditions. properties: priority: - description: Priority sets the priority for route. A higher value - sets a higher priority in route matching. + description: |- + Priority sets the priority for route. when multiple routes have the same URI path, + a higher value sets a higher priority in route matching. format: int64 type: integer targetRefs: @@ -3223,7 +3480,7 @@ spec: - name: v1alpha1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: - description: PluginConfig is the Schema for the PluginConfigs API. + description: PluginConfig defines plugin configuration. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -3245,10 +3502,10 @@ spec: spec: description: |- PluginConfigSpec defines the desired state of a PluginConfig, - in which plugins and their configurations are specified. + in which plugins and their configuration are specified. properties: plugins: - description: Plugins are an array of plugins and their configurations + description: Plugins are an array of plugins and their configuration to be applied. items: properties: diff --git a/charts/ingress-controller/crds/gwapi-crds.yaml b/charts/ingress-controller/crds/gwapi-crds.yaml index a797bdc..5b5a6d4 100644 --- a/charts/ingress-controller/crds/gwapi-crds.yaml +++ b/charts/ingress-controller/crds/gwapi-crds.yaml @@ -1,60 +1,58 @@ +# Copyright 2025 The Kubernetes Authors. +# +# Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); +# you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. +# You may obtain a copy of the License at +# +# http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 +# +# Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software +# distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, +# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. +# See the License for the specific language governing permissions and +# limitations under the License. + +# +# Gateway API Experimental channel install +# +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_backendtlspolicies.yaml +# apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 kind: CustomResourceDefinition metadata: annotations: api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.0 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental creationTimestamp: null - name: gatewayclasses.gateway.networking.k8s.io + labels: + gateway.networking.k8s.io/policy: Direct + name: backendtlspolicies.gateway.networking.k8s.io spec: group: gateway.networking.k8s.io names: categories: - gateway-api - kind: GatewayClass - listKind: GatewayClassList - plural: gatewayclasses + kind: BackendTLSPolicy + listKind: BackendTLSPolicyList + plural: backendtlspolicies shortNames: - - gc - singular: gatewayclass - scope: Cluster + - btlspolicy + singular: backendtlspolicy + scope: Namespaced versions: - additionalPrinterColumns: - - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName - name: Controller - type: string - - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status - name: Accepted - type: string - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp name: Age type: date - - jsonPath: .spec.description - name: Description - priority: 1 - type: string - name: v1 + name: v1alpha3 schema: openAPIV3Schema: description: |- - GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating - Gateway resources. - - It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This - means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it - was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not - propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to - limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters. - If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing - Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation. - - Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD - add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the - associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a - Gateway is not deleted while in use. - - GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource. + BackendTLSPolicy provides a way to configure how a Gateway + connects to a Backend via TLS. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -74,169 +72,586 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass. + description: Spec defines the desired state of BackendTLSPolicy. properties: - controllerName: + options: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string description: |- - ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of - this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path. - - Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS + configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the + minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites. - This field is not mutable and cannot be empty. + A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid + any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use + domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`. + Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API. - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ - type: string - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Value is immutable - rule: self == oldSelf - description: - description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details. - maxLength: 64 - type: string - parametersRef: + Support: Implementation-specific + maxProperties: 16 + type: object + targetRefs: description: |- - ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration - parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the - controller does not require any additional configuration. + TargetRefs identifies an API object to apply the policy to. + Only Services have Extended support. Implementations MAY support + additional objects, with Implementation Specific support. + Note that this config applies to the entire referenced resource + by default, but this default may change in the future to provide + a more granular application of the policy. - ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap, - or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be - cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped. + TargetRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that: - If the referent cannot be found, refers to an unsupported kind, or when - the data within that resource is malformed, the GatewayClass SHOULD be - rejected with the "Accepted" status condition set to "False" and an - "InvalidParameters" reason. + * They select different targets. If this is the case, then targetRef + entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the + multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, and `name` must + be unique across all targetRef entries in the BackendTLSPolicy. + * They select different sectionNames in the same target. - A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, - the merging behavior is implementation specific. - It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service - Support: Implementation-specific + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + items: + description: |- + LocalPolicyTargetReferenceWithSectionName identifies an API object to apply a + direct policy to. This should be used as part of Policy resources that can + target single resources. For more information on how this policy attachment + mode works, and a sample Policy resource, refer to the policy attachment + documentation for Gateway API. + + Note: This should only be used for direct policy attachment when references + to SectionName are actually needed. In all other cases, + LocalPolicyTargetReference should be used. + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the target resource. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the target resource. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the target resource. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. When + unspecified, this targetRef targets the entire resource. In the following + resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name + * HTTPRoute: HTTPRouteRule name + * Service: Port name + + If a SectionName is specified, but does not exist on the targeted object, + the Policy must fail to attach, and the policy implementation should record + a `ResolvedRefs` or similar Condition in the Policy's status. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: sectionName must be specified when targetRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same target + rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) || p1.sectionName + == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName == '''')) + : true))' + - message: sectionName must be unique when targetRefs includes 2 or + more references to the same target + rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.sectionName) || + p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)))) + validation: + description: Validation contains backend TLS validation configuration. properties: - group: - description: Group is the group of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: Kind is kind of the referent. - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - name: - description: Name is the name of the referent. + caCertificateRefs: + description: |- + CACertificateRefs contains one or more references to Kubernetes objects that + contain a PEM-encoded TLS CA certificate bundle, which is used to + validate a TLS handshake between the Gateway and backend Pod. + + If CACertificateRefs is empty or unspecified, then WellKnownCACertificates must be + specified. Only one of CACertificateRefs or WellKnownCACertificates may be specified, + not both. If CACertificateRefs is empty or unspecified, the configuration for + WellKnownCACertificates MUST be honored instead if supported by the implementation. + + References to a resource in a different namespace are invalid for the + moment, although we will revisit this in the future. + + A single CACertificateRef to a Kubernetes ConfigMap kind has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to + a backend, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + + Support: Core - An optional single reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap, + with the CA certificate in a key named `ca.crt`. + + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference, or other kinds + of resources). + items: + description: |- + LocalObjectReference identifies an API object within the namespace of the + referrer. + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example "HTTPRoute" + or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is used for two purposes in the connection between Gateways and + backends: + + 1. Hostname MUST be used as the SNI to connect to the backend (RFC 6066). + 2. Hostname MUST be used for authentication and MUST match the certificate served by the matching backend, unless SubjectAltNames is specified. + authentication and MUST match the certificate served by the matching + backend. + + Support: Core maxLength: 253 minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ type: string - namespace: + subjectAltNames: description: |- - Namespace is the namespace of the referent. - This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and - MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource. - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + SubjectAltNames contains one or more Subject Alternative Names. + When specified the certificate served from the backend MUST + have at least one Subject Alternate Name matching one of the specified SubjectAltNames. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: SubjectAltName represents Subject Alternative Name. + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname contains Subject Alternative Name specified in DNS name format. + Required when Type is set to Hostname, ignored otherwise. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type determines the format of the Subject Alternative Name. Always required. + + Support: Core + enum: + - Hostname + - URI + type: string + uri: + description: |- + URI contains Subject Alternative Name specified in a full URI format. + It MUST include both a scheme (e.g., "http" or "ftp") and a scheme-specific-part. + Common values include SPIFFE IDs like "spiffe://mycluster.example.com/ns/myns/sa/svc1sa". + Required when Type is set to URI, ignored otherwise. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(([^:/?#]+):)(//([^/?#]*))([^?#]*)(\?([^#]*))?(#(.*))? + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: SubjectAltName element must contain Hostname, if + Type is set to Hostname + rule: '!(self.type == "Hostname" && (!has(self.hostname) || + self.hostname == ""))' + - message: SubjectAltName element must not contain Hostname, + if Type is not set to Hostname + rule: '!(self.type != "Hostname" && has(self.hostname) && + self.hostname != "")' + - message: SubjectAltName element must contain URI, if Type + is set to URI + rule: '!(self.type == "URI" && (!has(self.uri) || self.uri + == ""))' + - message: SubjectAltName element must not contain URI, if Type + is not set to URI + rule: '!(self.type != "URI" && has(self.uri) && self.uri != + "")' + maxItems: 5 + type: array + wellKnownCACertificates: + description: |- + WellKnownCACertificates specifies whether system CA certificates may be used in + the TLS handshake between the gateway and backend pod. + + If WellKnownCACertificates is unspecified or empty (""), then CACertificateRefs + must be specified with at least one entry for a valid configuration. Only one of + CACertificateRefs or WellKnownCACertificates may be specified, not both. If an + implementation does not support the WellKnownCACertificates field or the value + supplied is not supported, the Status Conditions on the Policy MUST be + updated to include an Accepted: False Condition with Reason: Invalid. + + Support: Implementation-specific + enum: + - System type: string required: - - group - - kind - - name + - hostname type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: must not contain both CACertificateRefs and WellKnownCACertificates + rule: '!(has(self.caCertificateRefs) && size(self.caCertificateRefs) + > 0 && has(self.wellKnownCACertificates) && self.wellKnownCACertificates + != "")' + - message: must specify either CACertificateRefs or WellKnownCACertificates + rule: (has(self.caCertificateRefs) && size(self.caCertificateRefs) + > 0 || has(self.wellKnownCACertificates) && self.wellKnownCACertificates + != "") required: - - controllerName + - targetRefs + - validation type: object status: - default: - conditions: - - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" - message: Waiting for controller - reason: Pending - status: Unknown - type: Accepted - description: |- - Status defines the current state of GatewayClass. - - Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which - specify their controller name. + description: Status defines the current state of BackendTLSPolicy. properties: - conditions: - default: - - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" - message: Waiting for controller - reason: Pending - status: Unknown - type: Accepted + ancestors: description: |- - Conditions is the current status from the controller for - this GatewayClass. - - Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values - of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition. + Ancestors is a list of ancestor resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the policy, and the status of the policy with respect to + each ancestor. When this policy attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent and the ancestors MUST add an entry to this list when + the controller first sees the policy and SHOULD update the entry as + appropriate when the relevant ancestor is modified. + + Note that choosing the relevant ancestor is left to the Policy designers; + an important part of Policy design is designing the right object level at + which to namespace this status. + + Note also that implementations MUST ONLY populate ancestor status for + the Ancestor resources they are responsible for. Implementations MUST + use the ControllerName field to uniquely identify the entries in this list + that they are responsible for. + + Note that to achieve this, the list of PolicyAncestorStatus structs + MUST be treated as a map with a composite key, made up of the AncestorRef + and ControllerName fields combined. + + A maximum of 16 ancestors will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the Policy is not relevant for any ancestors. + + If this slice is full, implementations MUST NOT add further entries. + Instead they MUST consider the policy unimplementable and signal that + on any related resources such as the ancestor that would be referenced + here. For example, if this list was full on BackendTLSPolicy, no + additional Gateways would be able to reference the Service targeted by + the BackendTLSPolicy. items: - description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current - state of this API Resource. + description: |- + PolicyAncestorStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Ancestor. + + Ancestors refer to objects that are either the Target of a policy or above it + in terms of object hierarchy. For example, if a policy targets a Service, the + Policy's Ancestors are, in order, the Service, the HTTPRoute, the Gateway, and + the GatewayClass. Almost always, in this hierarchy, the Gateway will be the most + useful object to place Policy status on, so we recommend that implementations + SHOULD use Gateway as the PolicyAncestorStatus object unless the designers + have a _very_ good reason otherwise. + + In the context of policy attachment, the Ancestor is used to distinguish which + resource results in a distinct application of this policy. For example, if a policy + targets a Service, it may have a distinct result per attached Gateway. + + Policies targeting the same resource may have different effects depending on the + ancestors of those resources. For example, different Gateways targeting the same + Service may have different capabilities, especially if they have different underlying + implementations. + + For example, in BackendTLSPolicy, the Policy attaches to a Service that is + used as a backend in a HTTPRoute that is itself attached to a Gateway. + In this case, the relevant object for status is the Gateway, and that is the + ancestor object referred to in this status. + + Note that a parent is also an ancestor, so for objects where the parent is the + relevant object for status, this struct SHOULD still be used. + + This struct is intended to be used in a slice that's effectively a map, + with a composite key made up of the AncestorRef and the ControllerName. properties: - lastTransitionTime: - description: |- - lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. - This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. - format: date-time - type: string - message: - description: |- - message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. - This may be an empty string. - maxLength: 32768 - type: string - observedGeneration: - description: |- - observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. - For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date - with respect to the current state of the instance. - format: int64 - minimum: 0 - type: integer - reason: + ancestorRef: description: |- - reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. - Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, - and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. - The value should be a CamelCase string. - This field may not be empty. - maxLength: 1024 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ - type: string - status: - description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. - enum: - - "True" - - "False" - - Unknown - type: string - type: - description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. - maxLength: 316 - pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + AncestorRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + PolicyAncestorStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + conditions: + description: Conditions describes the status of the Policy with + respect to the given Ancestor. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. + + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). + + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ type: string required: - - lastTransitionTime - - message - - reason - - status - - type + - ancestorRef + - controllerName type: object - maxItems: 8 + maxItems: 16 type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - type - x-kubernetes-list-type: map + required: + - ancestors type: object required: - spec @@ -245,6 +660,38 @@ spec: storage: true subresources: status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gatewayclasses.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: gatewayclasses.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: GatewayClass + listKind: GatewayClassList + plural: gatewayclasses + shortNames: + - gc + singular: gatewayclass + scope: Cluster + versions: - additionalPrinterColumns: - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName name: Controller @@ -259,7 +706,7 @@ spec: name: Description priority: 1 type: string - name: v1beta1 + name: v1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: description: |- @@ -462,62 +909,68 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - type x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - required: - - spec - type: object - served: true - storage: false - subresources: + supportedFeatures: + description: |- + SupportedFeatures is the set of features the GatewayClass support. + It MUST be sorted in ascending alphabetical order by the Name key. + items: + properties: + name: + description: |- + FeatureName is used to describe distinct features that are covered by + conformance tests. + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: status: {} -status: - acceptedNames: - kind: "" - plural: "" - conditions: null - storedVersions: null ---- -apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 -kind: CustomResourceDefinition -metadata: - annotations: - api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.0 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard - creationTimestamp: null - name: gateways.gateway.networking.k8s.io -spec: - group: gateway.networking.k8s.io - names: - categories: - - gateway-api - kind: Gateway - listKind: GatewayList - plural: gateways - shortNames: - - gtw - singular: gateway - scope: Namespaced - versions: - additionalPrinterColumns: - - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName - name: Class - type: string - - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value - name: Address + - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName + name: Controller type: string - - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status - name: Programmed + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status + name: Accepted type: string - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp name: Age type: date - name: v1 + - jsonPath: .spec.description + name: Description + priority: 1 + type: string + name: v1beta1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: description: |- - Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure - by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses. + GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating + Gateway resources. + + It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This + means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it + was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not + propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to + limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters. + If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing + Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation. + + Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD + add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the + associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a + Gateway is not deleted while in use. + + GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -537,177 +990,586 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway. + description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass. properties: - addresses: - description: |+ - Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can - depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the - requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST - indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses. - - The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the - "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use. - This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or - other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will - be sent to. - - If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the - Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate - set of Addresses. - - The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that - it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in - GatewayStatus.Addresses. + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of + this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path. - Support: Extended + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". - items: - description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound - to a Gateway. - oneOf: - - properties: - type: - enum: - - IPAddress - value: - anyOf: - - format: ipv4 - - format: ipv6 - - properties: - type: - not: - enum: - - IPAddress - properties: - type: - default: IPAddress - description: Type of the address. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ - type: string - value: - description: |- - Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend - on the type and support by the controller. + This field is not mutable and cannot be empty. - Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - value - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching - ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) - rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): - true' - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: IPAddress values must be unique - rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2, - a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' - - message: Hostname values must be unique - rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2, - a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' - gatewayClassName: - description: |- - GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a - GatewayClass resource. + Support: Core maxLength: 253 minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ type: string - infrastructure: + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Value is immutable + rule: self == oldSelf + description: + description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details. + maxLength: 64 + type: string + parametersRef: description: |- - Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance. - - Support: Extended - properties: - annotations: - additionalProperties: - description: |- - AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used - for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes - annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based - on the entire size of the annotations struct. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 0 - type: string - description: |- - Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. - - For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources. - For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts. + ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration + parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the + controller does not require any additional configuration. - An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit. + ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap, + or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be + cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped. - Support: Extended - maxProperties: 8 - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Annotation keys must be in the form of an optional - DNS subdomain prefix followed by a required name segment of - up to 63 characters. - rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) - - message: If specified, the annotation key's prefix must be a - DNS subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. - rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) - labels: - additionalProperties: - description: |- - LabelValue is the value of a label in the Gateway API. This is used for validation - of maps such as Gateway infrastructure labels. This matches the Kubernetes - label validation rules: - * must be 63 characters or less (can be empty), - * unless empty, must begin and end with an alphanumeric character ([a-z0-9A-Z]), - * could contain dashes (-), underscores (_), dots (.), and alphanumerics between. + If the referent cannot be found, refers to an unsupported kind, or when + the data within that resource is malformed, the GatewayClass SHOULD be + rejected with the "Accepted" status condition set to "False" and an + "InvalidParameters" reason. - Valid values include: + A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, + the merging behavior is implementation specific. + It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. - * MyValue - * my.name - * 123-my-value - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 0 - pattern: ^(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])?$ - type: string + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: description: |- - Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. + This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and + MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + type: object + status: + default: + conditions: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + description: |- + Status defines the current state of GatewayClass. - For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources. - For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts. + Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which + specify their controller name. + properties: + conditions: + default: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + description: |- + Conditions is the current status from the controller for + this GatewayClass. - An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit. + Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values + of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current + state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + supportedFeatures: + description: |- + SupportedFeatures is the set of features the GatewayClass support. + It MUST be sorted in ascending alphabetical order by the Name key. + items: + properties: + name: + description: |- + FeatureName is used to describe distinct features that are covered by + conformance tests. + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: false + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gateways.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: gateways.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: Gateway + listKind: GatewayList + plural: gateways + shortNames: + - gtw + singular: gateway + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName + name: Class + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value + name: Address + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status + name: Programmed + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure + by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway. + properties: + addresses: + description: |- + Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can + depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the + requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST + indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses. - If an implementation maps these labels to Pods, or any other resource that would need to be recreated when labels - change, it SHOULD clearly warn about this behavior in documentation. + The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the + "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use. + This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or + other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will + be sent to. - Support: Extended - maxProperties: 8 - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Label keys must be in the form of an optional DNS subdomain - prefix followed by a required name segment of up to 63 characters. - rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) - - message: If specified, the label key's prefix must be a DNS - subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. - rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) - parametersRef: - description: |- - ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration - parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the - controller does not require any additional configuration. + If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the + Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate + set of Addresses. - This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis + The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that + it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in + GatewayStatus.Addresses. - The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, - the merging behavior is implementation specific. - It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + Support: Extended + items: + description: GatewaySpecAddress describes an address that can be + bound to a Gateway. + oneOf: + - properties: + type: + enum: + - IPAddress + value: + anyOf: + - format: ipv4 + - format: ipv6 + - properties: + type: + not: + enum: + - IPAddress + properties: + type: + default: IPAddress + description: Type of the address. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + value: + description: |- + When a value is unspecified, an implementation SHOULD automatically + assign an address matching the requested type if possible. - Support: Implementation-specific + If an implementation does not support an empty value, they MUST set the + "Programmed" condition in status to False with a reason of "AddressNotAssigned". + + Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. + maxLength: 253 + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) + rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): + true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: IPAddress values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + - message: Hostname values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + allowedListeners: + description: |- + AllowedListeners defines which ListenerSets can be attached to this Gateway. + While this feature is experimental, the default value is to allow no ListenerSets. + properties: + namespaces: + default: + from: None + description: |- + Namespaces defines which namespaces ListenerSets can be attached to this Gateway. + While this feature is experimental, the default value is to allow no ListenerSets. + properties: + from: + default: None + description: |- + From indicates where ListenerSets can attach to this Gateway. Possible + values are: + + * Same: Only ListenerSets in the same namespace may be attached to this Gateway. + * Selector: ListenerSets in namespaces selected by the selector may be attached to this Gateway. + * All: ListenerSets in all namespaces may be attached to this Gateway. + * None: Only listeners defined in the Gateway's spec are allowed + + While this feature is experimental, the default value None + enum: + - All + - Selector + - Same + - None + type: string + selector: + description: |- + Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case, + only ListenerSets in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this + Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From". + properties: + matchExpressions: + description: matchExpressions is a list of label selector + requirements. The requirements are ANDed. + items: + description: |- + A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that + relates the key and values. + properties: + key: + description: key is the label key that the selector + applies to. + type: string + operator: + description: |- + operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values. + Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist. + type: string + values: + description: |- + values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn, + the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist, + the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic + merge patch. + items: + type: string + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + required: + - key + - operator + type: object + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + matchLabels: + additionalProperties: + type: string + description: |- + matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels + map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the + operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed. + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic + type: object + type: object + backendTLS: + description: |- + BackendTLS configures TLS settings for when this Gateway is connecting to + backends with TLS. + + Support: Core + properties: + clientCertificateRef: + description: |- + ClientCertificateRef is a reference to an object that contains a Client + Certificate and the associated private key. + + References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + + ClientCertificateRef can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e. + Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources. + + This setting can be overridden on the service level by use of BackendTLSPolicy. + + Support: Core + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Secret + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example "Secret". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + type: object + gatewayClassName: + description: |- + GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a + GatewayClass resource. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + infrastructure: + description: |- + Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance. + + Support: Extended + properties: + annotations: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Annotation keys must be in the form of an optional + DNS subdomain prefix followed by a required name segment of + up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the annotation key's prefix must be a + DNS subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + labels: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + LabelValue is the value of a label in the Gateway API. This is used for validation + of maps such as Gateway infrastructure labels. This matches the Kubernetes + label validation rules: + * must be 63 characters or less (can be empty), + * unless empty, must begin and end with an alphanumeric character ([a-z0-9A-Z]), + * could contain dashes (-), underscores (_), dots (.), and alphanumerics between. + + Valid values include: + + * MyValue + * my.name + * 123-my-value + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 0 + pattern: ^(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])?$ + type: string + description: |- + Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit. + + If an implementation maps these labels to Pods, or any other resource that would need to be recreated when labels + change, it SHOULD clearly warn about this behavior in documentation. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Label keys must be in the form of an optional DNS subdomain + prefix followed by a required name segment of up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the label key's prefix must be a DNS + subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + parametersRef: + description: |- + ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration + parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the + controller does not require any additional configuration. + + This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis + + The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, + the merging behavior is implementation specific. + It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + + If the referent cannot be found, refers to an unsupported kind, or when + the data within that resource is malformed, the Gateway SHOULD be + rejected with the "Accepted" status condition set to "False" and an + "InvalidParameters" reason. + + Support: Implementation-specific properties: group: description: Group is the group of the referent. @@ -737,6 +1599,8 @@ spec: logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses. At least one Listener MUST be specified. + ## Distinct Listeners + Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway) MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than @@ -748,55 +1612,76 @@ spec: combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname. Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered - Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their - targeted conformance profile: + Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on the objects + they support: - HTTP Profile + HTTPRoute 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided - TLS Profile + TLSRoute 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough "Distinct" Listeners have the following property: - The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct - Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for + **The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct + Listener**. + + When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other Listener fields. - For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct: + When multiple listeners have the same value for the Protocol field, then + each of the Listeners with matching Protocol values MUST have different + values for other fields. + + The set of fields that MUST be different for a Listener differs per protocol. + The following rules define the rules for what fields MUST be considered for + Listeners to be distinct with each protocol currently defined in the + Gateway API spec. + + The set of listeners that all share a protocol value MUST have _different_ + values for _at least one_ of these fields to be distinct: + + * **HTTP, HTTPS, TLS**: Port, Hostname + * **TCP, UDP**: Port - 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP" - Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. - 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or - "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. - 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener - with the same Protocol has the same Port value. + One **very** important rule to call out involves what happens when an + implementation: - Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect - whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant - for HTTP or HTTPS protocols. + * Supports TCP protocol Listeners, as well as HTTP, HTTPS, or TLS protocol + Listeners, and + * sees HTTP, HTTPS, or TLS protocols with the same `port` as one with TCP + Protocol. - When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol - Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the - Listener to be distinct. + In this case all the Listeners that share a port with the + TCP Listener are not distinct and so MUST NOT be accepted. - When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request + If an implementation does not support TCP Protocol Listeners, then the + previous rule does not apply, and the TCP Listeners SHOULD NOT be + accepted. + + Note that the `tls` field is not used for determining if a listener is distinct, because + Listeners that _only_ differ on TLS config will still conflict in all cases. + + ### Listeners that are distinct only by Hostname + + When the Listeners are distinct based only on Hostname, inbound request hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes. - Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard - matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value) + Exact matches MUST be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard + matches MUST be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value) matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`. Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries. For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`. + The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence. @@ -804,18 +1689,26 @@ spec: the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`. + ## Handling indistinct Listeners + If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those - Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted" + Listeners are _Conflicted_, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted" condition in the Listener Status to "True". + The words "indistinct" and "conflicted" are considered equivalent for the + purpose of this documentation. + Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains - no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may - accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting - Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner. - This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting - Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at - least one Listener must be present. + no Conflicted Listeners. + + Specifically, an implementation MAY accept a partial Listener set subject to + the following rules: + + * The implementation MUST NOT pick one conflicting Listener as the winner. + ALL indistinct Listeners must not be accepted for processing. + * At least one distinct Listener MUST be present, or else the Gateway effectively + contains _no_ Listeners, and must be rejected from processing as a whole. The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or @@ -824,7 +1717,25 @@ spec: Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted. - A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if: + ## General Listener behavior + + Note that, for all distinct Listeners, requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. + For example, if Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a + request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached + to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener). + + This concept is known as "Listener Isolation", and it is an Extended feature + of Gateway API. Implementations that do not support Listener Isolation MUST + clearly document this, and MUST NOT claim support for the + `GatewayHTTPListenerIsolation` feature. + + Implementations that _do_ support Listener Isolation SHOULD claim support + for the Extended `GatewayHTTPListenerIsolation` feature and pass the associated + conformance tests. + + ## Compatible Listeners + + A Gateway's Listeners are considered _compatible_ if: 1. They are distinct. 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses @@ -839,16 +1750,11 @@ spec: on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct. - Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if - Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a - request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached - to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener). - This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do - not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this. - Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible. + In a future release the MinItems=1 requirement MAY be dropped. + Support: Core items: description: |- @@ -1010,10 +1916,31 @@ spec: * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI. * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request. - * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP - protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not - ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname, - it MUST clearly document that. + * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match both the SNI and Host header. + Note that this does not require the SNI and Host header to be the same. + The semantics of this are described in more detail below. + + To ensure security, Section 11.1 of RFC-6066 emphasizes that server + implementations that rely on SNI hostname matching MUST also verify + hostnames within the application protocol. + + Section 9.1.2 of RFC-7540 provides a mechanism for servers to reject the + reuse of a connection by responding with the HTTP 421 Misdirected Request + status code. This indicates that the origin server has rejected the + request because it appears to have been misdirected. + + To detect misdirected requests, Gateways SHOULD match the authority of + the requests with all the SNI hostname(s) configured across all the + Gateway Listeners on the same port and protocol: + + * If another Listener has an exact match or more specific wildcard entry, + the Gateway SHOULD return a 421. + * If the current Listener (selected by SNI matching during ClientHello) + does not match the Host: + * If another Listener does match the Host the Gateway SHOULD return a + 421. + * If no other Listener matches the Host, the Gateway MUST return a + 404. For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames, @@ -1152,6 +2079,93 @@ spec: type: object maxItems: 64 type: array + frontendValidation: + description: |- + FrontendValidation holds configuration information for validating the frontend (client). + Setting this field will require clients to send a client certificate + required for validation during the TLS handshake. In browsers this may result in a dialog appearing + that requests a user to specify the client certificate. + The maximum depth of a certificate chain accepted in verification is Implementation specific. + + Support: Extended + properties: + caCertificateRefs: + description: |- + CACertificateRefs contains one or more references to + Kubernetes objects that contain TLS certificates of + the Certificate Authorities that can be used + as a trust anchor to validate the certificates presented by the client. + + A single CA certificate reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap + has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple CA certificates to + a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + + Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap + with the CA certificate in a key named `ca.crt`. + + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference, or other kinds + of resources). + + References to a resource in a different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + items: + description: |- + ObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When set to the empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For + example "ConfigMap" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + type: object mode: default: Terminate description: |- @@ -1250,7 +2264,7 @@ spec: description: Status defines the current state of Gateway. properties: addresses: - description: |+ + description: |- Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the Gateway. @@ -1260,7 +2274,6 @@ spec: * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use) - items: description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that is bound to a Gateway. @@ -1502,1077 +2515,3598 @@ spec: a Route resource. properties: group: - default: gateway.networking.k8s.io - description: Group is the group of the Route. + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + required: + - attachedRoutes + - conditions + - name + - supportedKinds + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName + name: Class + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value + name: Address + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status + name: Programmed + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1beta1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure + by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway. + properties: + addresses: + description: |- + Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can + depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the + requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST + indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses. + + The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the + "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use. + This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or + other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will + be sent to. + + If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the + Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate + set of Addresses. + + The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that + it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in + GatewayStatus.Addresses. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: GatewaySpecAddress describes an address that can be + bound to a Gateway. + oneOf: + - properties: + type: + enum: + - IPAddress + value: + anyOf: + - format: ipv4 + - format: ipv6 + - properties: + type: + not: + enum: + - IPAddress + properties: + type: + default: IPAddress + description: Type of the address. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + value: + description: |- + When a value is unspecified, an implementation SHOULD automatically + assign an address matching the requested type if possible. + + If an implementation does not support an empty value, they MUST set the + "Programmed" condition in status to False with a reason of "AddressNotAssigned". + + Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. + maxLength: 253 + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) + rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): + true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: IPAddress values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + - message: Hostname values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + allowedListeners: + description: |- + AllowedListeners defines which ListenerSets can be attached to this Gateway. + While this feature is experimental, the default value is to allow no ListenerSets. + properties: + namespaces: + default: + from: None + description: |- + Namespaces defines which namespaces ListenerSets can be attached to this Gateway. + While this feature is experimental, the default value is to allow no ListenerSets. + properties: + from: + default: None + description: |- + From indicates where ListenerSets can attach to this Gateway. Possible + values are: + + * Same: Only ListenerSets in the same namespace may be attached to this Gateway. + * Selector: ListenerSets in namespaces selected by the selector may be attached to this Gateway. + * All: ListenerSets in all namespaces may be attached to this Gateway. + * None: Only listeners defined in the Gateway's spec are allowed + + While this feature is experimental, the default value None + enum: + - All + - Selector + - Same + - None + type: string + selector: + description: |- + Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case, + only ListenerSets in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this + Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From". + properties: + matchExpressions: + description: matchExpressions is a list of label selector + requirements. The requirements are ANDed. + items: + description: |- + A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that + relates the key and values. + properties: + key: + description: key is the label key that the selector + applies to. + type: string + operator: + description: |- + operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values. + Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist. + type: string + values: + description: |- + values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn, + the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist, + the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic + merge patch. + items: + type: string + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + required: + - key + - operator + type: object + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + matchLabels: + additionalProperties: + type: string + description: |- + matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels + map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the + operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed. + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic + type: object + type: object + backendTLS: + description: |- + BackendTLS configures TLS settings for when this Gateway is connecting to + backends with TLS. + + Support: Core + properties: + clientCertificateRef: + description: |- + ClientCertificateRef is a reference to an object that contains a Client + Certificate and the associated private key. + + References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + + ClientCertificateRef can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e. + Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources. + + This setting can be overridden on the service level by use of BackendTLSPolicy. + + Support: Core + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Secret + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example "Secret". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + type: object + gatewayClassName: + description: |- + GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a + GatewayClass resource. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + infrastructure: + description: |- + Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance. + + Support: Extended + properties: + annotations: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Annotation keys must be in the form of an optional + DNS subdomain prefix followed by a required name segment of + up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the annotation key's prefix must be a + DNS subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + labels: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + LabelValue is the value of a label in the Gateway API. This is used for validation + of maps such as Gateway infrastructure labels. This matches the Kubernetes + label validation rules: + * must be 63 characters or less (can be empty), + * unless empty, must begin and end with an alphanumeric character ([a-z0-9A-Z]), + * could contain dashes (-), underscores (_), dots (.), and alphanumerics between. + + Valid values include: + + * MyValue + * my.name + * 123-my-value + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 0 + pattern: ^(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])?$ + type: string + description: |- + Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit. + + If an implementation maps these labels to Pods, or any other resource that would need to be recreated when labels + change, it SHOULD clearly warn about this behavior in documentation. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Label keys must be in the form of an optional DNS subdomain + prefix followed by a required name segment of up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the label key's prefix must be a DNS + subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + parametersRef: + description: |- + ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration + parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the + controller does not require any additional configuration. + + This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis + + The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, + the merging behavior is implementation specific. + It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + + If the referent cannot be found, refers to an unsupported kind, or when + the data within that resource is malformed, the Gateway SHOULD be + rejected with the "Accepted" status condition set to "False" and an + "InvalidParameters" reason. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + type: object + listeners: + description: |- + Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define + logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses. + At least one Listener MUST be specified. + + ## Distinct Listeners + + Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway) + MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to + exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than + "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration + from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_ + apply in that case). + + Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique + combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname. + + Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered + Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on the objects + they support: + + HTTPRoute + + 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP + 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided + + TLSRoute + + 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough + + "Distinct" Listeners have the following property: + + **The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct + Listener**. + + When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for + example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation + can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other + Listener fields. + + When multiple listeners have the same value for the Protocol field, then + each of the Listeners with matching Protocol values MUST have different + values for other fields. + + The set of fields that MUST be different for a Listener differs per protocol. + The following rules define the rules for what fields MUST be considered for + Listeners to be distinct with each protocol currently defined in the + Gateway API spec. + + The set of listeners that all share a protocol value MUST have _different_ + values for _at least one_ of these fields to be distinct: + + * **HTTP, HTTPS, TLS**: Port, Hostname + * **TCP, UDP**: Port + + One **very** important rule to call out involves what happens when an + implementation: + + * Supports TCP protocol Listeners, as well as HTTP, HTTPS, or TLS protocol + Listeners, and + * sees HTTP, HTTPS, or TLS protocols with the same `port` as one with TCP + Protocol. + + In this case all the Listeners that share a port with the + TCP Listener are not distinct and so MUST NOT be accepted. + + If an implementation does not support TCP Protocol Listeners, then the + previous rule does not apply, and the TCP Listeners SHOULD NOT be + accepted. + + Note that the `tls` field is not used for determining if a listener is distinct, because + Listeners that _only_ differ on TLS config will still conflict in all cases. + + ### Listeners that are distinct only by Hostname + + When the Listeners are distinct based only on Hostname, inbound request + hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname + values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes. + + Exact matches MUST be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard + matches MUST be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value) + matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over + `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`. + + Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific + wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries. + For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`. + + The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the + hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence. + + The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to + the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both + `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`. + + ## Handling indistinct Listeners + + If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those + Listeners are _Conflicted_, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted" + condition in the Listener Status to "True". + + The words "indistinct" and "conflicted" are considered equivalent for the + purpose of this documentation. + + Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted + Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains + no Conflicted Listeners. + + Specifically, an implementation MAY accept a partial Listener set subject to + the following rules: + + * The implementation MUST NOT pick one conflicting Listener as the winner. + ALL indistinct Listeners must not be accepted for processing. + * At least one distinct Listener MUST be present, or else the Gateway effectively + contains _no_ Listeners, and must be rejected from processing as a whole. + + The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the + Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or + not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly + indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are + Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD + indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted. + + ## General Listener behavior + + Note that, for all distinct Listeners, requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. + For example, if Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a + request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached + to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener). + + This concept is known as "Listener Isolation", and it is an Extended feature + of Gateway API. Implementations that do not support Listener Isolation MUST + clearly document this, and MUST NOT claim support for the + `GatewayHTTPListenerIsolation` feature. + + Implementations that _do_ support Listener Isolation SHOULD claim support + for the Extended `GatewayHTTPListenerIsolation` feature and pass the associated + conformance tests. + + ## Compatible Listeners + + A Gateway's Listeners are considered _compatible_ if: + + 1. They are distinct. + 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses + requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned + addresses. + + Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across + implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation + may not be compatible for another. + + For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners + on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port + would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct. + + Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of + Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible. + + In a future release the MinItems=1 requirement MAY be dropped. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts + network connections. + properties: + allowedRoutes: + default: + namespaces: + from: Same + description: |- + AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a + Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be + present. + + Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule + may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria: + + * The most specific match as defined by the Route type. + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with + a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over + a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04". + * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in + alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For + example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz. + + All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be + implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean + the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid, + support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For + example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest + of the rules within that Route should still be supported. + + Support: Core + properties: + kinds: + description: |- + Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind + to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes + selected are determined using the Listener protocol. + + A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible + with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field. + If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it + MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the + "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. + + Support: Core + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind + of a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + namespaces: + default: + from: Same + description: |- + Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this + Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default. + + Support: Core + properties: + from: + default: Same + description: |- + From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible + values are: + + * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway. + * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by + this Gateway. + * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway. + + Support: Core + enum: + - All + - Selector + - Same + type: string + selector: + description: |- + Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case, + only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this + Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From". + + Support: Core + properties: + matchExpressions: + description: matchExpressions is a list of label + selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed. + items: + description: |- + A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that + relates the key and values. + properties: + key: + description: key is the label key that the + selector applies to. + type: string + operator: + description: |- + operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values. + Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist. + type: string + values: + description: |- + values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn, + the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist, + the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic + merge patch. + items: + type: string + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + required: + - key + - operator + type: object + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + matchLabels: + additionalProperties: + type: string + description: |- + matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels + map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the + operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed. + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic + type: object + type: object + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that + define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This + field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based + matching. + + Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of + the following protocols: + + * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI. + * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request. + * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match both the SNI and Host header. + Note that this does not require the SNI and Host header to be the same. + The semantics of this are described in more detail below. + + To ensure security, Section 11.1 of RFC-6066 emphasizes that server + implementations that rely on SNI hostname matching MUST also verify + hostnames within the application protocol. + + Section 9.1.2 of RFC-7540 provides a mechanism for servers to reject the + reuse of a connection by responding with the HTTP 421 Misdirected Request + status code. This indicates that the origin server has rejected the + request because it appears to have been misdirected. + + To detect misdirected requests, Gateways SHOULD match the authority of + the requests with all the SNI hostname(s) configured across all the + Gateway Listeners on the same port and protocol: + + * If another Listener has an exact match or more specific wildcard entry, + the Gateway SHOULD return a 421. + * If the current Listener (selected by SNI matching during ClientHello) + does not match the Host: + * If another Listener does match the Host the Gateway SHOULD return a + 421. + * If no other Listener matches the Host, the Gateway MUST return a + 404. + + For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the + `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames, + there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be + accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames + documentation. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a + Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the + same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules. + + Support: Core + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + protocol: + description: |- + Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 255 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$ + type: string + tls: + description: |- + TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if + the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field + if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP". + + The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is + defined based on the Hostname field for this listener. + + The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all + available certificates for any TLS handshake. + + Support: Core + properties: + certificateRefs: + description: |- + CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that + contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to + establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the + associated listener. + + A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to + a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + + References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + + This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set + to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise. + + CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e. + Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources. + + Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls + + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types) + items: + description: |- + SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace, + defaulting to Secret. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Secret + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "Secret". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + frontendValidation: + description: |- + FrontendValidation holds configuration information for validating the frontend (client). + Setting this field will require clients to send a client certificate + required for validation during the TLS handshake. In browsers this may result in a dialog appearing + that requests a user to specify the client certificate. + The maximum depth of a certificate chain accepted in verification is Implementation specific. + + Support: Extended + properties: + caCertificateRefs: + description: |- + CACertificateRefs contains one or more references to + Kubernetes objects that contain TLS certificates of + the Certificate Authorities that can be used + as a trust anchor to validate the certificates presented by the client. + + A single CA certificate reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap + has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple CA certificates to + a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + + Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap + with the CA certificate in a key named `ca.crt`. + + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference, or other kinds + of resources). + + References to a resource in a different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + items: + description: |- + ObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When set to the empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For + example "ConfigMap" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + type: object + mode: + default: Terminate + description: |- + Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client. + There are two possible modes: + + - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the + Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates + to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs + field. + - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This + implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for + the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field + is ignored in this mode. + + Support: Core + enum: + - Terminate + - Passthrough + type: string + options: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS + configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the + minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites. + + A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid + any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use + domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`. + Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API. + + Support: Implementation-specific + maxProperties: 16 + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when + mode is Terminate + rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs) + > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true' + required: + - name + - port + - protocol + type: object + maxItems: 64 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP', + 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? + !has(l.tls) : true)' + - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS + rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode + == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)' + - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname) + || l.hostname == '''') : true)' + - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway + rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name)) + - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique + for each listener + rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol + == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname + == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))' + required: + - gatewayClassName + - listeners + type: object + status: + default: + conditions: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed + description: Status defines the current state of Gateway. + properties: + addresses: + description: |- + Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the + Gateway. + + This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some + conditions: + + * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned + * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned + * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use) + items: + description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that + is bound to a Gateway. + oneOf: + - properties: + type: + enum: + - IPAddress + value: + anyOf: + - format: ipv4 + - format: ipv6 + - properties: + type: + not: + enum: + - IPAddress + properties: + type: + default: IPAddress + description: Type of the address. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + value: + description: |- + Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend + on the type and support by the controller. + + Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - value + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) + rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): + true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + conditions: + default: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed + description: |- + Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway. + + Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions + using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason` + constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common + vocabulary to describe Gateway state. + + Known condition types are: + + * "Accepted" + * "Programmed" + * "Ready" + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current + state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + listeners: + description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port + defined in the Spec. + items: + description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener. + properties: + attachedRoutes: + description: |- + AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been + successfully attached to this Listener. + + Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the + combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener + and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to + a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field + AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway + resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on + attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various + Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact + successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set + for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully + attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions. + + Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and + measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener. + format: int32 + type: integer + conditions: + description: Conditions describe the current condition of this + listener. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + name: + description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status + corresponds to. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + supportedKinds: + description: |- + SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this + listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for + that Listener configuration. + + If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT + appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" + condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid + and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST + reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified. + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of + a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + required: + - attachedRoutes + - conditions + - name + - supportedKinds + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: false + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_grpcroutes.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: grpcroutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: GRPCRoute + listKind: GRPCRouteList + plural: grpcroutes + singular: grpcroute + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames + name: Hostnames + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + GRPCRoute provides a way to route gRPC requests. This includes the capability + to match requests by hostname, gRPC service, gRPC method, or HTTP/2 header. + Filters can be used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify + where matching requests will be routed. + + GRPCRoute falls under extended support within the Gateway API. Within the + following specification, the word "MUST" indicates that an implementation + supporting GRPCRoute must conform to the indicated requirement, but an + implementation not supporting this route type need not follow the requirement + unless explicitly indicated. + + Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTPS` `ProtocolType` MUST + accept HTTP/2 connections without an initial upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. via + ALPN. If the implementation does not support this, then it MUST set the + "Accepted" condition to "False" for the affected listener with a reason of + "UnsupportedProtocol". Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections + with an upgrade from HTTP/1. + + Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTP` `ProtocolType` MUST + support HTTP/2 over cleartext TCP (h2c, + https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.1) without an initial + upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. with prior knowledge + (https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.4). If the implementation + does not support this, then it MUST set the "Accepted" condition to "False" + for the affected listener with a reason of "UnsupportedProtocol". + Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections with an upgrade from + HTTP/1, i.e. without prior knowledge. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of GRPCRoute. + properties: + hostnames: + description: |- + Hostnames defines a set of hostnames to match against the GRPC + Host header to select a GRPCRoute to process the request. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label MUST appear by itself as the first label. + + If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and GRPCRoute, there + MUST be at least one intersecting hostname for the GRPCRoute to be + attached to the Listener. For example: + + * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at + least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`. + * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least + one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example, + `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other + hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + + If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, any + GRPCRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be + ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the + GRPCRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, + `test.example.net` MUST NOT be considered for a match. + + If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, and none + match with the criteria above, then the GRPCRoute MUST NOT be accepted by + the implementation. The implementation MUST raise an 'Accepted' Condition + with a status of `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + + If a Route (A) of type HTTPRoute or GRPCRoute is attached to a + Listener and that listener already has another Route (B) of the other + type attached and the intersection of the hostnames of A and B is + non-empty, then the implementation MUST accept exactly one of these two + routes, determined by the following criteria, in order: + + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. + * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by + "{namespace}/{name}". + + The rejected Route MUST raise an 'Accepted' condition with a status of + 'False' in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. + + Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating + dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a + domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`). + + Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case + alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric + character. No other punctuation is allowed. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + parentRefs: + description: |- + ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants + to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to + allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means + the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and + namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same + namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support + and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is + not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to + create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the + Route. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that: + + * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef + entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the + multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must + be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route. + * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used, + each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of + optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a + combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination. + + Some examples: + + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the + same object must also set `sectionName`. + * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same + object must also set `port`. + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs + referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`. + + It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may + be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may + choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the + case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be + merged. + + Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific + rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example, + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. + + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + items: + description: |- + ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered + a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources + with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)): true))' + - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port + == p2.port)))) + rules: + description: Rules are a list of GRPC matchers, filters and actions. + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteRule defines the semantics for matching a gRPC request based on + conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to + an API object (backendRefs). + properties: + backendRefs: + description: |- + BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be + sent. + + Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and + how many are invalid. + + If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters + specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST + receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + + See the GRPCBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single + GRPCBackendRef invalid. + + When a GRPCBackendRef is invalid, `UNAVAILABLE` statuses MUST be returned for + requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If + multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of + requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend + MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + + For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is + invalid, 50 percent of traffic MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + Implementations may choose how that 50 percent is determined. + + Support: Core for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + + Support for weight: Core + items: + description: |- + GRPCBackendRef defines how a GRPCRoute forwards a gRPC request. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a + ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + + When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD + honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. + + Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes + Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. + + If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the + backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the + protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. + + If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified + protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the + "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. + properties: + filters: + description: |- + Filters defined at this level MUST be executed if and only if the + request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. + + Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the + Filters field in GRPCRouteRule.) + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. + + Support: Implementation-specific + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For + example "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. + + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |- + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. + + Support: Extended + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. + + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. + + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. + + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind + == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + fraction: + description: |- + Fraction represents the fraction of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + properties: + denominator: + default: 100 + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + numerator: + format: int32 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - numerator + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: numerator must be less than or equal + to denominator + rule: self.numerator <= self.denominator + percent: + description: |- + Percent represents the percentage of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. Its minimum value is 0 (indicating 0% of + requests) and its maximum value is 100 (indicating 100% of requests). + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + format: int32 + maximum: 100 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - backendRef + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Only one of percent or fraction may be + specified in HTTPRequestMirrorFilter + rule: '!(has(self.percent) && has(self.fraction))' + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. + + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |- + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: + + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + enum: + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - ExtensionRef + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for + RequestMirror filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == + ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for + ExtensionRef filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. maxLength: 253 pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ type: string kind: - description: Kind is the kind of the Route. - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - required: - - kind - type: object - maxItems: 8 - type: array - required: - - attachedRoutes - - conditions - - name - - supportedKinds - type: object - maxItems: 64 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - required: - - spec - type: object - served: true - storage: true - subresources: - status: {} - - additionalPrinterColumns: - - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName - name: Class - type: string - - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value - name: Address - type: string - - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status - name: Programmed - type: string - - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp - name: Age - type: date - name: v1beta1 - schema: - openAPIV3Schema: - description: |- - Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure - by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses. - properties: - apiVersion: - description: |- - APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. - Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and - may reject unrecognized values. - More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources - type: string - kind: - description: |- - Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. - Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. - Cannot be updated. - In CamelCase. - More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds - type: string - metadata: - type: object - spec: - description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway. - properties: - addresses: - description: |+ - Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can - depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the - requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST - indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses. + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". - The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the - "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use. - This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or - other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will - be sent to. + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. - If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the - Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate - set of Addresses. + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. - The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that - it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in - GatewayStatus.Addresses. + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) - Support: Extended + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. - items: - description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound - to a Gateway. - oneOf: - - properties: - type: - enum: - - IPAddress - value: - anyOf: - - format: ipv4 - - format: ipv6 - - properties: - type: - not: - enum: - - IPAddress - properties: - type: - default: IPAddress - description: Type of the address. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ - type: string - value: - description: |- - Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend - on the type and support by the controller. + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. - Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - value - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching - ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) - rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): - true' - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: IPAddress values must be unique - rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2, - a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' - - message: Hostname values must be unique - rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2, - a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' - gatewayClassName: - description: |- - GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a - GatewayClass resource. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - infrastructure: - description: |- - Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + weight: + default: 1 + description: |- + Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced + backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this + BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from + the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an + implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of + weights does not need to equal 100. - Support: Extended - properties: - annotations: - additionalProperties: - description: |- - AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used - for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes - annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based - on the entire size of the annotations struct. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 0 - type: string - description: |- - Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100% + of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no + traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight + defaults to 1. - For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources. - For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts. + Support for this field varies based on the context where used. + format: int32 + maximum: 1000000 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + filters: + description: |- + Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match + this rule. - An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit. + The effects of ordering of multiple behaviors are currently unspecified. + This can change in the future based on feedback during the alpha stage. - Support: Extended - maxProperties: 8 - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Annotation keys must be in the form of an optional - DNS subdomain prefix followed by a required name segment of - up to 63 characters. - rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) - - message: If specified, the annotation key's prefix must be a - DNS subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. - rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) - labels: - additionalProperties: - description: |- - LabelValue is the value of a label in the Gateway API. This is used for validation - of maps such as Gateway infrastructure labels. This matches the Kubernetes - label validation rules: - * must be 63 characters or less (can be empty), - * unless empty, must begin and end with an alphanumeric character ([a-z0-9A-Z]), - * could contain dashes (-), underscores (_), dots (.), and alphanumerics between. + Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter: - Valid values include: + - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations that support + GRPCRoute. + - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters. + - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across + implementations. - * MyValue - * my.name - * 123-my-value - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 0 - pattern: ^(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])?$ - type: string - description: |- - Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly + indicated in the filter. - For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources. - For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts. + If an implementation cannot support a combination of filters, it must clearly + document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported + filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status + `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify + this configuration error. - An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit. + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. - If an implementation maps these labels to Pods, or any other resource that would need to be recreated when labels - change, it SHOULD clearly warn about this behavior in documentation. + Support: Implementation-specific - Support: Extended - maxProperties: 8 - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Label keys must be in the form of an optional DNS subdomain - prefix followed by a required name segment of up to 63 characters. - rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) - - message: If specified, the label key's prefix must be a DNS - subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. - rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) - parametersRef: - description: |- - ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration - parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the - controller does not require any additional configuration. + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. - This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. - The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, - the merging behavior is implementation specific. - It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo - Support: Implementation-specific - properties: - group: - description: Group is the group of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: Kind is kind of the referent. - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - name: - description: Name is the name of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - group - - kind - - name - type: object - type: object - listeners: - description: |- - Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define - logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses. - At least one Listener MUST be specified. + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" - Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway) - MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to - exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than - "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration - from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_ - apply in that case). + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). - Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique - combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname. + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). - Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered - Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their - targeted conformance profile: + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz - HTTP Profile + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] - 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP - 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. - TLS Profile + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo - 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" - "Distinct" Listeners have the following property: + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). - The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct - Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for - example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation - can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other - Listener fields. + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |- + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. - For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct: + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. - 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP" - Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. - 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or - "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. - 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener - with the same Protocol has the same Port value. + Support: Extended + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. - Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect - whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant - for HTTP or HTTPS protocols. + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. - When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol - Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the - Listener to be distinct. + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. - When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request - hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname - values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes. + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. - Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard - matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value) - matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over - `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`. + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. - Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific - wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries. - For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`. - The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the - hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence. + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service - The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to - the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both - `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`. + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". - If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those - Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted" - condition in the Listener Status to "True". + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. - Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted - Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains - no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may - accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting - Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner. - This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting - Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at - least one Listener must be present. + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. - The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the - Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or - not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly - indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are - Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD - indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted. + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) - A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if: + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. - 1. They are distinct. - 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses - requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned - addresses. + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. - Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across - implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation - may not be compatible for another. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + fraction: + description: |- + Fraction represents the fraction of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. - For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners - on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port - would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct. + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + properties: + denominator: + default: 100 + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + numerator: + format: int32 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - numerator + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: numerator must be less than or equal to + denominator + rule: self.numerator <= self.denominator + percent: + description: |- + Percent represents the percentage of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. Its minimum value is 0 (indicating 0% of + requests) and its maximum value is 100 (indicating 100% of requests). - Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if - Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a - request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached - to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener). - This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do - not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this. + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + format: int32 + maximum: 100 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - backendRef + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Only one of percent or fraction may be specified + in HTTPRequestMirrorFilter + rule: '!(has(self.percent) && has(self.fraction))' + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. - Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of - Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible. + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. - Support: Core - items: - description: |- - Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts - network connections. - properties: - allowedRoutes: - default: - namespaces: - from: Same - description: |- - AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a - Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be - present. + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo - Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule - may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be - determined in order of the following criteria: + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" - * The most specific match as defined by the Route type. - * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with - a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over - a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04". - * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in - alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For - example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz. + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). - All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be - implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean - the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid, - support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For - example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest - of the rules within that Route should still be supported. + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). - Support: Core - properties: - kinds: - description: |- - Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind - to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes - selected are determined using the Listener protocol. + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz - A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible - with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field. - If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it - MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the - "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] - Support: Core - items: - description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind - of a Route resource. - properties: - group: - default: gateway.networking.k8s.io - description: Group is the group of the Route. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: Kind is the kind of the Route. - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - required: - - kind - type: object - maxItems: 8 - type: array - namespaces: - default: - from: Same - description: |- - Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this - Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default. + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. - Support: Core - properties: - from: - default: Same - description: |- - From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible - values are: + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo - * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway. - * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by - this Gateway. - * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway. + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" - Support: Core - enum: - - All - - Selector - - Same - type: string - selector: - description: |- - Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case, - only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this - Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From". + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). - Support: Core - properties: - matchExpressions: - description: matchExpressions is a list of label - selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed. - items: - description: |- - A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that - relates the key and values. - properties: - key: - description: key is the label key that the - selector applies to. - type: string - operator: - description: |- - operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values. - Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist. - type: string - values: - description: |- - values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn, - the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist, - the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic - merge patch. - items: - type: string - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic - required: - - key - - operator - type: object - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic - matchLabels: - additionalProperties: - type: string - description: |- - matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels - map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the - operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed. + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value type: object - type: object - x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic - type: object - type: object - hostname: - description: |- - Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that - define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This - field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based - matching. + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |- + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: - Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of - the following protocols: + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters. - * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI. - * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request. - * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP - protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not - ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname, - it MUST clearly document that. + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. - For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the - `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames, - there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be - accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames - documentation. + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + enum: + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - ExtensionRef + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type == + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + matches: + description: |- + Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming + gRPC requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched + if **any** one of the matches is satisfied. - Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted - as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match - both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + For example, take the following matches configuration: - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a - Gateway. + ``` + matches: + - method: + service: foo.bar + headers: + values: + version: 2 + - method: + service: foo.bar.v2 + ``` - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - port: - description: |- - Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the - same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules. + For a request to match against this rule, it MUST satisfy + EITHER of the two conditions: - Support: Core - format: int32 - maximum: 65535 - minimum: 1 - type: integer - protocol: - description: |- - Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive. + - service of foo.bar AND contains the header `version: 2` + - service of foo.bar.v2 - Support: Core - maxLength: 255 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$ - type: string - tls: - description: |- - TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if - the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field - if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP". + See the documentation for GRPCRouteMatch on how to specify multiple + match conditions to be ANDed together. - The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is - defined based on the Hostname field for this listener. + If no matches are specified, the implementation MUST match every gRPC request. - The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all - available certificates for any TLS handshake. + Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from GRPCRoutes + MUST prioritize rules based on the following criteria, continuing on + ties. Merging MUST not be done between GRPCRoutes and HTTPRoutes. + Precedence MUST be given to the rule with the largest number of: - Support: Core - properties: - certificateRefs: - description: |- - CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that - contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to - establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the - associated listener. + * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname. + * Characters in a matching hostname. + * Characters in a matching service. + * Characters in a matching method. + * Header matches. - A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support. - Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to - a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties: - References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there - is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate - to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the - "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the - "RefNotPermitted" reason. + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. + * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by + "{namespace}/{name}". - This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set - to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise. + If ties still exist within the Route that has been given precedence, + matching precedence MUST be granted to the first matching rule meeting + the above criteria. + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteMatch defines the predicate used to match requests to a given + action. Multiple match types are ANDed together, i.e. the match will + evaluate to true only if all conditions are satisfied. - CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e. - Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources. + For example, the match below will match a gRPC request only if its service + is `foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header: - Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls + ``` + matches: + - method: + type: Exact + service: "foo" + headers: + - name: "version" + value "v1" - Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types) - items: + ``` + properties: + headers: description: |- - SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace, - defaulting to Secret. - - The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must - be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + Headers specifies gRPC request header matchers. Multiple match values are + ANDed together, meaning, a request MUST match all the specified headers + to select the route. + items: + description: |- + GRPCHeaderMatch describes how to select a gRPC route by matching gRPC request + headers. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the gRPC Header to be matched. - References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must - be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set - on the containing object. + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first + entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent + entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: Type specifies how to match against + the value of the header. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of the gRPC Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + method: + description: |- + Method specifies a gRPC request service/method matcher. If this field is + not specified, all services and methods will match. properties: - group: - default: "" + method: description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". - When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - default: Secret - description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example - "Secret". - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + Value of the method to match against. If left empty or omitted, will + match all services. + + At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string. + maxLength: 1024 type: string - name: - description: Name is the name of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 + service: + description: |- + Value of the service to match against. If left empty or omitted, will + match any service. + + At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string. + maxLength: 1024 type: string - namespace: + type: + default: Exact description: |- - Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local - namespace is inferred. + Type specifies how to match against the service and/or method. + Support: Core (Exact with service and method specified) - Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, - a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that - namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant - documentation for details. + Support: Implementation-specific (Exact with method specified but no service specified) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: One or both of 'service' or 'method' must be + specified + rule: 'has(self.type) ? has(self.service) || has(self.method) + : true' + - message: service must only contain valid characters + (matching ^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$) + rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') && + has(self.service) ? self.service.matches(r"""^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$"""): + true' + - message: method must only contain valid characters (matching + ^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$) + rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') && + has(self.method) ? self.method.matches(r"""^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$"""): + true' + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the route rule. This name MUST be unique within a Route if it is set. - Support: Core - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ - type: string - required: - - name - type: object - maxItems: 64 - type: array - mode: - default: Terminate + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + sessionPersistence: + description: |- + SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence + for the route rule. + + Support: Extended + properties: + absoluteTimeout: description: |- - Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client. - There are two possible modes: + AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent + session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the + session becomes invalid. - - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the - Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates - to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs - field. - - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This - implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for - the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field - is ignored in this mode. + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + cookieConfig: + description: |- + CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific + to cookie-based session persistence. Support: Core - enum: - - Terminate - - Passthrough - type: string - options: - additionalProperties: - description: |- - AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used - for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes - annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based - on the entire size of the annotations struct. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 0 - type: string + properties: + lifetimeType: + default: Session + description: |- + LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or + session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its + specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie + attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current + session ends. + + When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes + and is required. + + When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and + is optional. + + Defaults to "Session". + + Support: Core for "Session" type + + Support: Extended for "Permanent" type + enum: + - Permanent + - Session + type: string + type: object + idleTimeout: description: |- - Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS - configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the - minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites. + IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session. + Once the session has been idle for more than the specified + IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid. - A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid - any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use - domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`. - Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API. + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + sessionName: + description: |- + SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token + which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users + should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended + consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior. Support: Implementation-specific - maxProperties: 16 - type: object + maxLength: 128 + type: string + type: + default: Cookie + description: |- + Type defines the type of session persistence such as through + the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session + persistence. + + Support: Core for "Cookie" type + + Support: Extended for "Header" type + enum: + - Cookie + - Header + type: string type: object x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when - mode is Terminate - rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs) - > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true' - required: - - name - - port - - protocol + - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType + is Permanent + rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig) || !has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) + || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)' type: object - maxItems: 64 - minItems: 1 + maxItems: 16 type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP', - 'UDP'] - rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? - !has(l.tls) : true)' - - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS - rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode - == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)' - - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP'] - rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname) - || l.hostname == '''') : true)' - - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway - rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name)) - - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique - for each listener - rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol - == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname - == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))' - required: - - gatewayClassName - - listeners + - message: While 16 rules and 64 matches per rule are allowed, the + total number of matches across all rules in a route must be less + than 128 + rule: '(self.size() > 0 ? (has(self[0].matches) ? self[0].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 1 ? (has(self[1].matches) ? self[1].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 2 ? (has(self[2].matches) ? self[2].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 3 ? (has(self[3].matches) ? self[3].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 4 ? (has(self[4].matches) ? self[4].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 5 ? (has(self[5].matches) ? self[5].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 6 ? (has(self[6].matches) ? self[6].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 7 ? (has(self[7].matches) ? self[7].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 8 ? (has(self[8].matches) ? self[8].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 9 ? (has(self[9].matches) ? self[9].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 10 ? (has(self[10].matches) ? self[10].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 11 ? (has(self[11].matches) ? self[11].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? (has(self[12].matches) ? self[12].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 13 ? (has(self[13].matches) ? self[13].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? (has(self[14].matches) ? self[14].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? (has(self[15].matches) ? self[15].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) <= 128' + - message: Rule name must be unique within the route + rule: self.all(l1, !has(l1.name) || self.exists_one(l2, has(l2.name) + && l1.name == l2.name)) type: object status: - default: - conditions: - - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" - message: Waiting for controller - reason: Pending - status: Unknown - type: Accepted - - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" - message: Waiting for controller - reason: Pending - status: Unknown - type: Programmed - description: Status defines the current state of Gateway. + description: Status defines the current state of GRPCRoute. properties: - addresses: - description: |+ - Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the - Gateway. + parents: + description: |- + Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to + each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller + first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the + route or gateway is modified. + + Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation + of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API + can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are + responsible for. + + A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + items: + description: |- + RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Parent. + properties: + conditions: + description: |- + Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. + Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own + status conditions and listener status. + + If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports + Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, + then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the + Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the + Gateway, and why. + + A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's + rules is implemented by the Gateway. + + There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set + due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: + + * The Route refers to a nonexistent parent. + * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. + * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. - This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some - conditions: + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". - * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned - * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned - * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use) + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). - items: - description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that - is bound to a Gateway. - oneOf: - - properties: - type: - enum: - - IPAddress - value: - anyOf: - - format: ipv4 - - format: ipv6 - - properties: - type: - not: - enum: - - IPAddress - properties: - type: - default: IPAddress - description: Type of the address. + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. maxLength: 253 minLength: 1 - pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ type: string - value: + parentRef: description: |- - Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend - on the type and support by the controller. + ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). - Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - value - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching - ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) - rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): - true' - maxItems: 16 - type: array - conditions: - default: - - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" - message: Waiting for controller - reason: Pending - status: Unknown - type: Accepted - - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" - message: Waiting for controller - reason: Pending - status: Unknown - type: Programmed - description: |- - Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. - Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions - using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason` - constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common - vocabulary to describe Gateway state. + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: - Known condition types are: + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - * "Accepted" - * "Programmed" - * "Ready" - items: - description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current - state of this API Resource. - properties: - lastTransitionTime: - description: |- - lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. - This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. - format: date-time - type: string - message: - description: |- - message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. - This may be an empty string. - maxLength: 32768 - type: string - observedGeneration: - description: |- - observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. - For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date - with respect to the current state of the instance. - format: int64 - minimum: 0 - type: integer - reason: - description: |- - reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. - Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, - and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. - The value should be a CamelCase string. - This field may not be empty. - maxLength: 1024 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ - type: string - status: - description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. - enum: - - "True" - - "False" - - Unknown - type: string - type: - description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. - maxLength: 316 - pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ - type: string - required: - - lastTransitionTime - - message - - reason - - status - - type - type: object - maxItems: 8 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - type - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - listeners: - description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port - defined in the Spec. - items: - description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener. - properties: - attachedRoutes: - description: |- - AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been - successfully attached to this Listener. + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. - Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the - combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener - and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to - a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field - AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway - resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on - attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various - Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact - successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set - for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully - attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. - Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and - measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener. - format: int32 - type: integer - conditions: - description: Conditions describe the current condition of this - listener. - items: - description: Condition contains details for one aspect of - the current state of this API Resource. - properties: - lastTransitionTime: - description: |- - lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. - This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. - format: date-time - type: string - message: - description: |- - message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. - This may be an empty string. - maxLength: 32768 - type: string - observedGeneration: - description: |- - observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. - For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date - with respect to the current state of the instance. - format: int64 - minimum: 0 - type: integer - reason: - description: |- - reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. - Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, - and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. - The value should be a CamelCase string. - This field may not be empty. - maxLength: 1024 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ - type: string - status: - description: status of the condition, one of True, False, - Unknown. - enum: - - "True" - - "False" - - Unknown - type: string - type: - description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. - maxLength: 316 - pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ - type: string - required: - - lastTransitionTime - - message - - reason - - status - - type - type: object - maxItems: 8 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - type - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - name: - description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status - corresponds to. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - supportedKinds: - description: |- - SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this - listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for - that Listener configuration. + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT - appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" - condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid - and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST - reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified. - items: - description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of - a Route resource. - properties: - group: - default: gateway.networking.k8s.io - description: Group is the group of the Route. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: Kind is the kind of the Route. - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - required: - - kind - type: object - maxItems: 8 - type: array + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object required: - - attachedRoutes - - conditions - - name - - supportedKinds + - controllerName + - parentRef type: object - maxItems: 64 + maxItems: 32 type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map + required: + - parents type: object - required: - - spec type: object served: true - storage: false + storage: true subresources: status: {} status: @@ -2582,24 +6116,27 @@ status: conditions: null storedVersions: null --- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_httproutes.yaml +# apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 kind: CustomResourceDefinition metadata: annotations: api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.0 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental creationTimestamp: null - name: grpcroutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io + name: httproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io spec: group: gateway.networking.k8s.io names: categories: - gateway-api - kind: GRPCRoute - listKind: GRPCRouteList - plural: grpcroutes - singular: grpcroute + kind: HTTPRoute + listKind: HTTPRouteList + plural: httproutes + singular: httproute scope: Namespaced versions: - additionalPrinterColumns: @@ -2613,33 +6150,10 @@ spec: schema: openAPIV3Schema: description: |- - GRPCRoute provides a way to route gRPC requests. This includes the capability - to match requests by hostname, gRPC service, gRPC method, or HTTP/2 header. - Filters can be used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify - where matching requests will be routed. - - GRPCRoute falls under extended support within the Gateway API. Within the - following specification, the word "MUST" indicates that an implementation - supporting GRPCRoute must conform to the indicated requirement, but an - implementation not supporting this route type need not follow the requirement - unless explicitly indicated. - - Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTPS` `ProtocolType` MUST - accept HTTP/2 connections without an initial upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. via - ALPN. If the implementation does not support this, then it MUST set the - "Accepted" condition to "False" for the affected listener with a reason of - "UnsupportedProtocol". Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections - with an upgrade from HTTP/1. - - Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTP` `ProtocolType` MUST - support HTTP/2 over cleartext TCP (h2c, - https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.1) without an initial - upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. with prior knowledge - (https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.4). If the implementation - does not support this, then it MUST set the "Accepted" condition to "False" - for the affected listener with a reason of "UnsupportedProtocol". - Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections with an upgrade from - HTTP/1, i.e. without prior knowledge. + HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability + to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be + used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching + requests should be routed. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -2659,58 +6173,61 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: Spec defines the desired state of GRPCRoute. + description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute. properties: hostnames: description: |- - Hostnames defines a set of hostnames to match against the GRPC - Host header to select a GRPCRoute to process the request. This matches - the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host + header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations + MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while + performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification + configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend. + + Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a + hostname with 2 notable exceptions: 1. IPs are not allowed. 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard - label MUST appear by itself as the first label. + label must appear by itself as the first label. - If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and GRPCRoute, there - MUST be at least one intersecting hostname for the GRPCRoute to be + If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there + must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be attached to the Listener. For example: - * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes + * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`. - * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes + * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example, - `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other - hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match. + `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would + all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would + not match. Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. - If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, any - GRPCRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be + If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any + HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the - GRPCRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, - `test.example.net` MUST NOT be considered for a match. + HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, + `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match. - If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, and none - match with the criteria above, then the GRPCRoute MUST NOT be accepted by - the implementation. The implementation MUST raise an 'Accepted' Condition - with a status of `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none + match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The + implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of + `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. - If a Route (A) of type HTTPRoute or GRPCRoute is attached to a - Listener and that listener already has another Route (B) of the other - type attached and the intersection of the hostnames of A and B is - non-empty, then the implementation MUST accept exactly one of these two - routes, determined by the following criteria, in order: + In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g. + overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must + be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of: - * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. - * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by - "{namespace}/{name}". + * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname. + * Characters in a matching hostname. - The rejected Route MUST raise an 'Accepted' condition with a status of - 'False' in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for + HTTPRouteMatches takes over. Support: Core items: @@ -2736,7 +6253,7 @@ spec: maxItems: 16 type: array parentRefs: - description: |+ + description: |- ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means @@ -2789,10 +6306,15 @@ spec: generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - - - + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. items: description: |- ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered @@ -2855,6 +6377,16 @@ spec: generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + Support: Core maxLength: 63 @@ -2875,6 +6407,10 @@ spec: must match both specified values. + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly @@ -2929,32 +6465,38 @@ spec: maxItems: 32 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes + - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes 2 or more references to the same parent rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && - p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName - == '''')) : true))' - - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or - more references to the same parent + == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)): true))' + - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName - == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName - == p2.sectionName)))) + == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port + == p2.port)))) rules: - description: |+ - Rules are a list of GRPC matchers, filters and actions. - + default: + - matches: + - path: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions. items: description: |- - GRPCRouteRule defines the semantics for matching a gRPC request based on + HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to an API object (backendRefs). properties: @@ -2968,36 +6510,42 @@ spec: If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST - receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + receive a 500 status code. - See the GRPCBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single - GRPCBackendRef invalid. + See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single + HTTPBackendRef invalid. - When a GRPCBackendRef is invalid, `UNAVAILABLE` statuses MUST be returned for + When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend - MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + MUST receive a 500 status code. For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is - invalid, 50 percent of traffic MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. - Implementations may choose how that 50 percent is determined. + invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may + choose how that 50 percent is determined. + + When a HTTPBackendRef refers to a Service that has no ready endpoints, + implementations SHOULD return a 503 for requests to that backend instead. + If an implementation chooses to do this, all of the above rules for 500 responses + MUST also apply for responses that return a 503. Support: Core for Kubernetes Service + Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource Support for weight: Core items: description: |- - GRPCBackendRef defines how a GRPCRoute forwards a gRPC request. + HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request. Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant documentation for details. - When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. @@ -3012,25 +6560,306 @@ spec: If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. - - properties: filters: description: |- - Filters defined at this level MUST be executed if and only if the + Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the - Filters field in GRPCRouteRule.) + Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.) items: description: |- - GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the - request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension + HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some examples include request or response modification, implementing authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. properties: + cors: + description: |- + CORS defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + cross-origin request based on HTTP response header. + + Support: Extended + properties: + allowCredentials: + description: |- + AllowCredentials indicates whether the actual cross-origin request allows + to include credentials. + + The only valid value for the `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` response + header is true (case-sensitive). + + If the credentials are not allowed in cross-origin requests, the gateway + will omit the header `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` entirely rather + than setting its value to false. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - true + type: boolean + allowHeaders: + description: |- + AllowHeaders indicates which HTTP request headers are supported for + accessing the requested resource. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + When the `AllowHeaders` field is configured with one or more headers, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + which value is present in the `AllowHeaders` field. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` request header + is not included in the list of header names specified by the response + header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers`, it will present an error on the + client side. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + does not recognize by the client, it will also occur an error on the + client side. + + A wildcard indicates that the requests with all HTTP headers are allowed. + The `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowHeaders` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one or more + HTTP headers in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response + header. The value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` is same as + the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` header provided by the client. If + the header `Access-Control-Request-Headers` is not included in the + request, the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header, instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway + implementation may choose to add implementation-specific default headers. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: + + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" + + Invalid values include: + + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + allowMethods: + description: |- + AllowMethods indicates which HTTP methods are supported for accessing the + requested resource. + + Valid values are any method defined by RFC9110, along with the special + value `*`, which represents all HTTP methods are allowed. + + Method names are case sensitive, so these values are also case-sensitive. + (See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2616#section-5.1.1) + + Multiple method names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A CORS-safelisted method is a method that is `GET`, `HEAD`, or `POST`. + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-method) The + CORS-safelisted methods are always allowed, regardless of whether they + are specified in the `AllowMethods` field. + + When the `AllowMethods` field is configured with one or more methods, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header + which value is present in the `AllowMethods` field. + + If the HTTP method of the `Access-Control-Request-Method` request header + is not included in the list of methods specified by the response header + `Access-Control-Allow-Methods`, it will present an error on the client + side. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowMethods` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one HTTP method + in the value of the Access-Control-Allow-Methods response header. The + value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` is same as the + `Access-Control-Request-Method` header provided by the client. If the + header `Access-Control-Request-Method` is not included in the request, + the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway implementation may + choose to add implementation-specific default methods. + + Support: Extended + items: + enum: + - GET + - HEAD + - POST + - PUT + - DELETE + - CONNECT + - OPTIONS + - TRACE + - PATCH + - '*' + type: string + maxItems: 9 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: AllowMethods cannot contain '*' alongside + other methods + rule: '!(''*'' in self && self.size() > 1)' + allowOrigins: + description: |- + AllowOrigins indicates whether the response can be shared with requested + resource from the given `Origin`. + + The `Origin` consists of a scheme and a host, with an optional port, and + takes the form `://(:)`. + + Valid values for scheme are: `http` and `https`. + + Valid values for port are any integer between 1 and 65535 (the list of + available TCP/UDP ports). Note that, if not included, port `80` is + assumed for `http` scheme origins, and port `443` is assumed for `https` + origins. This may affect origin matching. + + The host part of the origin may contain the wildcard character `*`. These + wildcard characters behave as follows: + + * `*` is a greedy match to the _left_, including any number of + DNS labels to the left of its position. This also means that + `*` will include any number of period `.` characters to the + left of its position. + * A wildcard by itself matches all hosts. + + An origin value that includes _only_ the `*` character indicates requests + from all `Origin`s are allowed. + + When the `AllowOrigins` field is configured with multiple origins, it + means the server supports clients from multiple origins. If the request + `Origin` matches the configured allowed origins, the gateway must return + the given `Origin` and sets value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` same as the `Origin` header provided by the + client. + + The status code of a successful response to a "preflight" request is + always an OK status (i.e., 204 or 200). + + If the request `Origin` does not match the configured allowed origins, + the gateway returns 204/200 response but doesn't set the relevant + cross-origin response headers. Alternatively, the gateway responds with + 403 status to the "preflight" request is denied, coupled with omitting + the CORS headers. The cross-origin request fails on the client side. + Therefore, the client doesn't attempt the actual cross-origin request. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowOrigins` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must return a single origin + in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. The value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` is same as the `Origin` header provided by + the client. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + The AbsoluteURI MUST NOT be a relative URI, and it MUST follow the URI syntax and + encoding rules specified in RFC3986. The AbsoluteURI MUST include both a + scheme (e.g., "http" or "spiffe") and a scheme-specific-part. URIs that + include an authority MUST include a fully qualified domain name or + IP address as the host. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(([^:/?#]+):)(//([^/?#]*))([^?#]*)(\?([^#]*))?(#(.*))? + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + exposeHeaders: + description: |- + ExposeHeaders indicates which HTTP response headers can be exposed + to client-side scripts in response to a cross-origin request. + + A CORS-safelisted response header is an HTTP header in a CORS response + that it is considered safe to expose to the client scripts. + The CORS-safelisted response headers include the following headers: + `Cache-Control` + `Content-Language` + `Content-Length` + `Content-Type` + `Expires` + `Last-Modified` + `Pragma` + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-response-header-name) + The CORS-safelisted response headers are exposed to client by default. + + When an HTTP header name is specified using the `ExposeHeaders` field, + this additional header will be exposed as part of the response to the + client. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A wildcard indicates that the responses with all HTTP headers are exposed + to clients. The `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` response header can only + use `*` wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is + unspecified. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: + + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" + + Invalid values include: + + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + maxAge: + default: 5 + description: |- + MaxAge indicates the duration (in seconds) for the client to cache the + results of a "preflight" request. + + The information provided by the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` and + `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response headers can be cached by the + client until the time specified by `Access-Control-Max-Age` elapses. + + The default value of `Access-Control-Max-Age` response header is 5 + (seconds). + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + type: object extensionRef: description: |- ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the @@ -3038,9 +6867,9 @@ spec: "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and extended filters. - Support: Implementation-specific - This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + + Support: Implementation-specific properties: group: description: |- @@ -3099,7 +6928,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -3174,7 +7003,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -3202,7 +7031,7 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-type: map type: object requestMirror: - description: |+ + description: |- RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from that destination are ignored. @@ -3212,7 +7041,6 @@ spec: backends. Support: Extended - properties: backendRef: description: |- @@ -3307,9 +7135,202 @@ spec: - message: Must have port for Service reference rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + fraction: + description: |- + Fraction represents the fraction of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + properties: + denominator: + default: 100 + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + numerator: + format: int32 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - numerator + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: numerator must be less than or equal + to denominator + rule: self.numerator <= self.denominator + percent: + description: |- + Percent represents the percentage of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. Its minimum value is 0 (indicating 0% of + requests) and its maximum value is 100 (indicating 100% of requests). + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + format: int32 + maximum: 100 + minimum: 0 + type: integer required: - backendRef type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Only one of percent or fraction may be + specified in HTTPRequestMirrorFilter + rule: '!(has(self.percent) && has(self.fraction))' + requestRedirect: + description: |- + RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + request with an HTTP redirection. + + Support: Core + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. + The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When + empty, the request path is used as-is. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? + has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when + replaceFullPath is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type + == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + when replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + port: + description: |- + Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + + If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the + following rules: + + * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known + port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 + and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a + well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. + * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway + Listener port. + + Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' + header in the following cases: + + * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. + * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + scheme: + description: |- + Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in + the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + + Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, + refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - http + - https + type: string + statusCode: + default: 302 + description: |- + StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Core + enum: + - 301 + - 302 + type: integer + type: object responseHeaderModifier: description: |- ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response @@ -3343,7 +7364,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -3418,7 +7439,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -3446,23 +7467,24 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-type: map type: object type: - description: |+ + description: |- Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, types are classified into three conformance levels: - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All - implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters. + implementations must support core filters. - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters. - - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors. + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by + specific vendors. In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters - is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to @@ -3472,12 +7494,105 @@ spec: MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. enum: - - ResponseHeaderModifier - RequestHeaderModifier + - ResponseHeaderModifier - RequestMirror + - RequestRedirect + - URLRewrite - ExtensionRef + - CORS type: string + urlRewrite: + description: |- + URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + + Support: Extended + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during + forwarding. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines a path rewrite. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? + has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when + replaceFullPath is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type + == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + when replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + type: object required: - type type: object @@ -3505,21 +7620,54 @@ spec: RequestMirror filter.type rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the + filter.type is not RequestRedirect + rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != + ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified + for RequestRedirect filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == + ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type + is not URLRewrite + rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type is not ExtensionRef rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef filter.type rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.cors must be nil if the filter.type + is not CORS + rule: '!(has(self.cors) && self.type != ''CORS'')' + - message: filter.cors must be specified for CORS filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.cors) && self.type == ''CORS'')' maxItems: 16 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') + && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') + && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() <= 1 - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() <= 1 + - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() + <= 1 + - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() + <= 1 group: default: "" description: |- @@ -3614,13 +7762,23 @@ spec: Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match this rule. - The effects of ordering of multiple behaviors are currently unspecified. - This can change in the future based on feedback during the alpha stage. + Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order + they are specified. + + Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting + any combination or order of filters that cannot be supported. If implementations + choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document + that behavior. + + To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD + consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules + in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only + a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the + "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route. Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter: - - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations that support - GRPCRoute. + - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations. - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters. - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across implementations. @@ -3628,22 +7786,307 @@ spec: Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly indicated in the filter. - If an implementation can not support a combination of filters, it must clearly - document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported - filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status - `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify - this configuration error. + All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the + URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an + implementation cannot support other combinations of filters, they must clearly + document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported + filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status + `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify + this configuration error. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + cors: + description: |- + CORS defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + cross-origin request based on HTTP response header. + + Support: Extended + properties: + allowCredentials: + description: |- + AllowCredentials indicates whether the actual cross-origin request allows + to include credentials. + + The only valid value for the `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` response + header is true (case-sensitive). + + If the credentials are not allowed in cross-origin requests, the gateway + will omit the header `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` entirely rather + than setting its value to false. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - true + type: boolean + allowHeaders: + description: |- + AllowHeaders indicates which HTTP request headers are supported for + accessing the requested resource. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + When the `AllowHeaders` field is configured with one or more headers, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + which value is present in the `AllowHeaders` field. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` request header + is not included in the list of header names specified by the response + header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers`, it will present an error on the + client side. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + does not recognize by the client, it will also occur an error on the + client side. + + A wildcard indicates that the requests with all HTTP headers are allowed. + The `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowHeaders` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one or more + HTTP headers in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response + header. The value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` is same as + the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` header provided by the client. If + the header `Access-Control-Request-Headers` is not included in the + request, the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header, instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway + implementation may choose to add implementation-specific default headers. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: + + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" + + Invalid values include: + + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + allowMethods: + description: |- + AllowMethods indicates which HTTP methods are supported for accessing the + requested resource. + + Valid values are any method defined by RFC9110, along with the special + value `*`, which represents all HTTP methods are allowed. + + Method names are case sensitive, so these values are also case-sensitive. + (See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2616#section-5.1.1) + + Multiple method names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A CORS-safelisted method is a method that is `GET`, `HEAD`, or `POST`. + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-method) The + CORS-safelisted methods are always allowed, regardless of whether they + are specified in the `AllowMethods` field. + + When the `AllowMethods` field is configured with one or more methods, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header + which value is present in the `AllowMethods` field. + + If the HTTP method of the `Access-Control-Request-Method` request header + is not included in the list of methods specified by the response header + `Access-Control-Allow-Methods`, it will present an error on the client + side. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowMethods` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one HTTP method + in the value of the Access-Control-Allow-Methods response header. The + value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` is same as the + `Access-Control-Request-Method` header provided by the client. If the + header `Access-Control-Request-Method` is not included in the request, + the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway implementation may + choose to add implementation-specific default methods. + + Support: Extended + items: + enum: + - GET + - HEAD + - POST + - PUT + - DELETE + - CONNECT + - OPTIONS + - TRACE + - PATCH + - '*' + type: string + maxItems: 9 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: AllowMethods cannot contain '*' alongside + other methods + rule: '!(''*'' in self && self.size() > 1)' + allowOrigins: + description: |- + AllowOrigins indicates whether the response can be shared with requested + resource from the given `Origin`. + + The `Origin` consists of a scheme and a host, with an optional port, and + takes the form `://(:)`. + + Valid values for scheme are: `http` and `https`. + + Valid values for port are any integer between 1 and 65535 (the list of + available TCP/UDP ports). Note that, if not included, port `80` is + assumed for `http` scheme origins, and port `443` is assumed for `https` + origins. This may affect origin matching. + + The host part of the origin may contain the wildcard character `*`. These + wildcard characters behave as follows: + + * `*` is a greedy match to the _left_, including any number of + DNS labels to the left of its position. This also means that + `*` will include any number of period `.` characters to the + left of its position. + * A wildcard by itself matches all hosts. + + An origin value that includes _only_ the `*` character indicates requests + from all `Origin`s are allowed. + + When the `AllowOrigins` field is configured with multiple origins, it + means the server supports clients from multiple origins. If the request + `Origin` matches the configured allowed origins, the gateway must return + the given `Origin` and sets value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` same as the `Origin` header provided by the + client. + + The status code of a successful response to a "preflight" request is + always an OK status (i.e., 204 or 200). + + If the request `Origin` does not match the configured allowed origins, + the gateway returns 204/200 response but doesn't set the relevant + cross-origin response headers. Alternatively, the gateway responds with + 403 status to the "preflight" request is denied, coupled with omitting + the CORS headers. The cross-origin request fails on the client side. + Therefore, the client doesn't attempt the actual cross-origin request. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowOrigins` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must return a single origin + in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. The value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` is same as the `Origin` header provided by + the client. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + The AbsoluteURI MUST NOT be a relative URI, and it MUST follow the URI syntax and + encoding rules specified in RFC3986. The AbsoluteURI MUST include both a + scheme (e.g., "http" or "spiffe") and a scheme-specific-part. URIs that + include an authority MUST include a fully qualified domain name or + IP address as the host. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(([^:/?#]+):)(//([^/?#]*))([^?#]*)(\?([^#]*))?(#(.*))? + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + exposeHeaders: + description: |- + ExposeHeaders indicates which HTTP response headers can be exposed + to client-side scripts in response to a cross-origin request. + + A CORS-safelisted response header is an HTTP header in a CORS response + that it is considered safe to expose to the client scripts. + The CORS-safelisted response headers include the following headers: + `Cache-Control` + `Content-Language` + `Content-Length` + `Content-Type` + `Expires` + `Last-Modified` + `Pragma` + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-response-header-name) + The CORS-safelisted response headers are exposed to client by default. + + When an HTTP header name is specified using the `ExposeHeaders` field, + this additional header will be exposed as part of the response to the + client. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A wildcard indicates that the responses with all HTTP headers are exposed + to clients. The `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` response header can only + use `*` wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is + unspecified. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: + + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" + + Invalid values include: + + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + maxAge: + default: 5 + description: |- + MaxAge indicates the duration (in seconds) for the client to cache the + results of a "preflight" request. - Support: Core - items: - description: |- - GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the - request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension - point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some - examples include request or response modification, implementing - authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API - guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. - properties: + The information provided by the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` and + `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response headers can be cached by the + client until the time specified by `Access-Control-Max-Age` elapses. + + The default value of `Access-Control-Max-Age` response header is 5 + (seconds). + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + type: object extensionRef: description: |- ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the @@ -3651,9 +8094,9 @@ spec: "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and extended filters. - Support: Implementation-specific - This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + + Support: Implementation-specific properties: group: description: |- @@ -3711,7 +8154,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -3785,7 +8228,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -3813,7 +8256,7 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-type: map type: object requestMirror: - description: |+ + description: |- RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from that destination are ignored. @@ -3823,7 +8266,6 @@ spec: backends. Support: Extended - properties: backendRef: description: |- @@ -3918,9 +8360,202 @@ spec: - message: Must have port for Service reference rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + fraction: + description: |- + Fraction represents the fraction of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + properties: + denominator: + default: 100 + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + numerator: + format: int32 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - numerator + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: numerator must be less than or equal to + denominator + rule: self.numerator <= self.denominator + percent: + description: |- + Percent represents the percentage of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. Its minimum value is 0 (indicating 0% of + requests) and its maximum value is 100 (indicating 100% of requests). + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + format: int32 + maximum: 100 + minimum: 0 + type: integer required: - backendRef type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Only one of percent or fraction may be specified + in HTTPRequestMirrorFilter + rule: '!(has(self.percent) && has(self.fraction))' + requestRedirect: + description: |- + RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + request with an HTTP redirection. + + Support: Core + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. + The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When + empty, the request path is used as-is. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath + is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == + ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when + replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + port: + description: |- + Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + + If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the + following rules: + + * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known + port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 + and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a + well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. + * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway + Listener port. + + Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' + header in the following cases: + + * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. + * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + scheme: + description: |- + Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in + the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + + Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, + refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - http + - https + type: string + statusCode: + default: 302 + description: |- + StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Core + enum: + - 301 + - 302 + type: integer + type: object responseHeaderModifier: description: |- ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response @@ -3953,7 +8588,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -4027,7 +8662,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -4055,38 +8690,132 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-type: map type: object type: - description: |+ + description: |- Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, types are classified into three conformance levels: - - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by - "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All - implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters. + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations must support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by + specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - RequestHeaderModifier + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - RequestRedirect + - URLRewrite + - ExtensionRef + - CORS + type: string + urlRewrite: + description: |- + URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + + Support: Extended + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during + forwarding. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines a path rewrite. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". - - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by - "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers - are encouraged to support extended filters. + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. - - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors. - In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple - implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core - conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters - is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to - "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. - Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to - extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. - If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter - MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by - that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. - enum: - - ResponseHeaderModifier - - RequestHeaderModifier - - RequestMirror - - ExtensionRef - type: string + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath + is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == + ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when + replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + type: object required: - type type: object @@ -4113,61 +8842,95 @@ spec: - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror filter.type rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestRedirect + rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type + is not URLRewrite + rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type is not ExtensionRef rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef filter.type rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.cors must be nil if the filter.type is not + CORS + rule: '!(has(self.cors) && self.type != ''CORS'')' + - message: filter.cors must be specified for CORS filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.cors) && self.type == ''CORS'')' maxItems: 16 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') && + self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() <= 1 - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() <= 1 + - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <= + 1 + - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1 matches: + default: + - path: + type: PathPrefix + value: / description: |- Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming - gRPC requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched + HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched if **any** one of the matches is satisfied. For example, take the following matches configuration: ``` matches: - - method: - service: foo.bar + - path: + value: "/foo" headers: - values: - version: 2 - - method: - service: foo.bar.v2 + - name: "version" + value: "v2" + - path: + value: "/v2/foo" ``` - For a request to match against this rule, it MUST satisfy + For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy EITHER of the two conditions: - - service of foo.bar AND contains the header `version: 2` - - service of foo.bar.v2 + - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2` + - path prefix of `/v2/foo` - See the documentation for GRPCRouteMatch on how to specify multiple - match conditions to be ANDed together. + See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple + match conditions that should be ANDed together. - If no matches are specified, the implementation MUST match every gRPC request. + If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix + path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every + HTTP request. - Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from GRPCRoutes - MUST prioritize rules based on the following criteria, continuing on - ties. Merging MUST not be done between GRPCRoutes and HTTPRoutes. - Precedence MUST be given to the rule with the largest number of: + Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes + MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on + ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be + given to the match having: - * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname. - * Characters in a matching hostname. - * Characters in a matching service. - * Characters in a matching method. - * Header matches. + * "Exact" path match. + * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters. + * Method match. + * Largest number of header matches. + * Largest number of query param matches. + + Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific. If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties: @@ -4176,64 +8939,231 @@ spec: * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by "{namespace}/{name}". - If ties still exist within the Route that has been given precedence, - matching precedence MUST be granted to the first matching rule meeting - the above criteria. + If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted + to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above + criteria. + + When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the + parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned. items: - description: |- - GRPCRouteMatch defines the predicate used to match requests to a given - action. Multiple match types are ANDed together, i.e. the match will - evaluate to true only if all conditions are satisfied. + description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to + match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types + are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true + only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\nFor example, the + match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts + with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\tpath:\n\t + \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t + \ value \"v1\"\n\n```" + properties: + headers: + description: |- + Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are + ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers + to select the route. + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request + headers. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). - For example, the match below will match a gRPC request only if its service - is `foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header: + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first + entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent + entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + + When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is + implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented. + Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC: + https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding + processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie". + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the value of the header. + + Support: Core (Exact) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + + Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific + conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects + of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to + determine the supported dialect. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to + be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + method: + description: |- + Method specifies HTTP method matcher. + When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the + specified method. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - GET + - HEAD + - POST + - PUT + - DELETE + - CONNECT + - OPTIONS + - TRACE + - PATCH + type: string + path: + default: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: |- + Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not + specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided. + properties: + type: + default: PathPrefix + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the path Value. - ``` - matches: - - method: - type: Exact - service: "foo" - headers: - - name: "version" - value "v1" + Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix) - ``` - properties: - headers: + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + enum: + - Exact + - PathPrefix + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + default: / + description: Value of the HTTP path to match against. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: value must be an absolute path and start with + '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'') + : true' + - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'') + : true' + - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'') + : true' + - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix', + 'RegularExpression'] + rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type + == 'RegularExpression' + - message: must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$) + for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""") + : true' + queryParams: description: |- - Headers specifies gRPC request header matchers. Multiple match values are - ANDed together, meaning, a request MUST match all the specified headers - to select the route. + QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match + values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the + specified query parameters to select the route. + + Support: Extended items: description: |- - GRPCHeaderMatch describes how to select a gRPC route by matching gRPC request - headers. + HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP + query parameters. properties: name: description: |- - Name is the name of the gRPC Header to be matched. + Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an + exact string match. (See + https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3). - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first + If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent - entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. + entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored. + + If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is + purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different + capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should + match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it, + as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of + the Gateway API. + + Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard + themselves against potential differences in the implementations. maxLength: 256 minLength: 1 pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ type: string type: default: Exact - description: Type specifies how to match against - the value of the header. + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter. + + Support: Extended (Exact) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + + Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific + conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other + dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's + documentation to determine the supported dialect. enum: - Exact - RegularExpression type: string value: - description: Value is the value of the gRPC Header + description: Value is the value of HTTP query param to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 + maxLength: 1024 minLength: 1 type: string required: @@ -4245,86 +9175,320 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - name x-kubernetes-list-type: map - method: + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the route rule. This name MUST be unique within a Route if it is set. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + retry: + description: |- + Retry defines the configuration for when to retry an HTTP request. + + Support: Extended + properties: + attempts: + description: |- + Attempts specifies the maximum number of times an individual request + from the gateway to a backend should be retried. + + If the maximum number of retries has been attempted without a successful + response from the backend, the Gateway MUST return an error. + + When this field is unspecified, the number of times to attempt to retry + a backend request is implementation-specific. + + Support: Extended + type: integer + backoff: + description: |- + Backoff specifies the minimum duration a Gateway should wait between + retry attempts and is represented in Gateway API Duration formatting. + + For example, setting the `rules[].retry.backoff` field to the value + `100ms` will cause a backend request to first be retried approximately + 100 milliseconds after timing out or receiving a response code configured + to be retryable. + + An implementation MAY use an exponential or alternative backoff strategy + for subsequent retry attempts, MAY cap the maximum backoff duration to + some amount greater than the specified minimum, and MAY add arbitrary + jitter to stagger requests, as long as unsuccessful backend requests are + not retried before the configured minimum duration. + + If a Request timeout (`rules[].timeouts.request`) is configured on the + route, the entire duration of the initial request and any retry attempts + MUST not exceed the Request timeout duration. If any retry attempts are + still in progress when the Request timeout duration has been reached, + these SHOULD be canceled if possible and the Gateway MUST immediately + return a timeout error. + + If a BackendRequest timeout (`rules[].timeouts.backendRequest`) is + configured on the route, any retry attempts which reach the configured + BackendRequest timeout duration without a response SHOULD be canceled if + possible and the Gateway should wait for at least the specified backoff + duration before attempting to retry the backend request again. + + If a BackendRequest timeout is _not_ configured on the route, retry + attempts MAY time out after an implementation default duration, or MAY + remain pending until a configured Request timeout or implementation + default duration for total request time is reached. + + When this field is unspecified, the time to wait between retry attempts + is implementation-specific. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + codes: + description: |- + Codes defines the HTTP response status codes for which a backend request + should be retried. + + Support: Extended + items: description: |- - Method specifies a gRPC request service/method matcher. If this field is - not specified, all services and methods will match. - properties: - method: - description: |- - Value of the method to match against. If left empty or omitted, will - match all services. + HTTPRouteRetryStatusCode defines an HTTP response status code for + which a backend request should be retried. + + Implementations MUST support the following status codes as retryable: + + * 500 + * 502 + * 503 + * 504 + + Implementations MAY support specifying additional discrete values in the + 500-599 range. + + Implementations MAY support specifying discrete values in the 400-499 range, + which are often inadvisable to retry. + maximum: 599 + minimum: 400 + type: integer + type: array + type: object + sessionPersistence: + description: |- + SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence + for the route rule. + + Support: Extended + properties: + absoluteTimeout: + description: |- + AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent + session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the + session becomes invalid. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + cookieConfig: + description: |- + CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific + to cookie-based session persistence. + + Support: Core + properties: + lifetimeType: + default: Session + description: |- + LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or + session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its + specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie + attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current + session ends. + + When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes + and is required. + + When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and + is optional. + + Defaults to "Session". + + Support: Core for "Session" type + + Support: Extended for "Permanent" type + enum: + - Permanent + - Session + type: string + type: object + idleTimeout: + description: |- + IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session. + Once the session has been idle for more than the specified + IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + sessionName: + description: |- + SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token + which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users + should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended + consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior. + + Support: Implementation-specific + maxLength: 128 + type: string + type: + default: Cookie + description: |- + Type defines the type of session persistence such as through + the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session + persistence. + + Support: Core for "Cookie" type + + Support: Extended for "Header" type + enum: + - Cookie + - Header + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType + is Permanent + rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig) || !has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) + || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)' + timeouts: + description: |- + Timeouts defines the timeouts that can be configured for an HTTP request. + + Support: Extended + properties: + backendRequest: + description: |- + BackendRequest specifies a timeout for an individual request from the gateway + to a backend. This covers the time from when the request first starts being + sent from the gateway to when the full response has been received from the backend. + + Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout + completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST + instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which + the timeout can be set. + + An entire client HTTP transaction with a gateway, covered by the Request timeout, + may result in more than one call from the gateway to the destination backend, + for example, if automatic retries are supported. + + The value of BackendRequest must be a Gateway API Duration string as defined by + GEP-2257. When this field is unspecified, its behavior is implementation-specific; + when specified, the value of BackendRequest must be no more than the value of the + Request timeout (since the Request timeout encompasses the BackendRequest timeout). + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + request: + description: |- + Request specifies the maximum duration for a gateway to respond to an HTTP request. + If the gateway has not been able to respond before this deadline is met, the gateway + MUST return a timeout error. + + For example, setting the `rules.timeouts.request` field to the value `10s` in an + `HTTPRoute` will cause a timeout if a client request is taking longer than 10 seconds + to complete. - At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string. - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - service: - description: |- - Value of the service to match against. If left empty or omitted, will - match any service. + Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout + completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST + instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which + the timeout can be set. - At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string. - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - type: - default: Exact - description: |- - Type specifies how to match against the service and/or method. - Support: Core (Exact with service and method specified) + This timeout is intended to cover as close to the whole request-response transaction + as possible although an implementation MAY choose to start the timeout after the entire + request stream has been received instead of immediately after the transaction is + initiated by the client. - Support: Implementation-specific (Exact with method specified but no service specified) + The value of Request is a Gateway API Duration string as defined by GEP-2257. When this + field is unspecified, request timeout behavior is implementation-specific. - Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) - enum: - - Exact - - RegularExpression - type: string - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: One or both of 'service' or 'method' must be - specified - rule: 'has(self.type) ? has(self.service) || has(self.method) - : true' - - message: service must only contain valid characters - (matching ^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$) - rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') && - has(self.service) ? self.service.matches(r"""^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$"""): - true' - - message: method must only contain valid characters (matching - ^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$) - rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') && - has(self.method) ? self.method.matches(r"""^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$"""): - true' - type: object - maxItems: 8 - type: array + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: backendRequest timeout cannot be longer than request + timeout + rule: '!(has(self.request) && has(self.backendRequest) && + duration(self.request) != duration(''0s'') && duration(self.backendRequest) + > duration(self.request))' type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with + backendRefs + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ? + (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))): + true' + - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, + exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified + rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) + && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) + ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || + self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) + : true' + - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, + exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified + rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) + && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches) + != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type + != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' + - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter + with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must + be specified + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, + (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) + && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) + )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) + || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) + : true' + - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with + path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be + specified + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, + (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) + && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches) + != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type + != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' maxItems: 16 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: - message: While 16 rules and 64 matches per rule are allowed, the total number of matches across all rules in a route must be less than 128 - rule: '(self.size() > 0 ? (has(self[0].matches) ? self[0].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 1 ? (has(self[1].matches) ? self[1].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 2 ? (has(self[2].matches) ? self[2].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 3 ? (has(self[3].matches) ? self[3].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 4 ? (has(self[4].matches) ? self[4].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 5 ? (has(self[5].matches) ? self[5].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 6 ? (has(self[6].matches) ? self[6].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 7 ? (has(self[7].matches) ? self[7].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 8 ? (has(self[8].matches) ? self[8].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 9 ? (has(self[9].matches) ? self[9].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 10 ? (has(self[10].matches) ? self[10].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 11 ? (has(self[11].matches) ? self[11].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? (has(self[12].matches) ? self[12].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 13 ? (has(self[13].matches) ? self[13].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? (has(self[14].matches) ? self[14].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? (has(self[15].matches) ? self[15].matches.size() - : 0) : 0) <= 128' + rule: '(self.size() > 0 ? self[0].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 1 ? self[1].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 2 ? self[2].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 3 ? self[3].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 4 ? self[4].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 5 ? self[5].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 6 ? self[6].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 7 ? self[7].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 8 ? self[8].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 9 ? self[9].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 10 ? self[10].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 11 ? self[11].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? self[12].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 13 ? self[13].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? self[14].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? self[15].matches.size() : 0) <= 128' + - message: Rule name must be unique within the route + rule: self.all(l1, !has(l1.name) || self.exists_one(l2, has(l2.name) + && l1.name == l2.name)) type: object status: - description: Status defines the current state of GRPCRoute. + description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute. properties: parents: description: |- @@ -4365,7 +9529,7 @@ spec: There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: - * The Route refers to a non-existent parent. + * The Route refers to a nonexistent parent. * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. items: @@ -4500,6 +9664,16 @@ spec: generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + Support: Core maxLength: 63 @@ -4520,6 +9694,10 @@ spec: must match both specified values. + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly @@ -4580,38 +9758,13 @@ spec: required: - parents type: object + required: + - spec type: object served: true storage: true subresources: status: {} -status: - acceptedNames: - kind: "" - plural: "" - conditions: null - storedVersions: null ---- -apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 -kind: CustomResourceDefinition -metadata: - annotations: - api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.0 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard - creationTimestamp: null - name: httproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io -spec: - group: gateway.networking.k8s.io - names: - categories: - - gateway-api - kind: HTTPRoute - listKind: HTTPRouteList - plural: httproutes - singular: httproute - scope: Namespaced - versions: - additionalPrinterColumns: - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames name: Hostnames @@ -4619,7 +9772,7 @@ spec: - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp name: Age type: date - name: v1 + name: v1beta1 schema: openAPIV3Schema: description: |- @@ -4726,7 +9879,7 @@ spec: maxItems: 16 type: array parentRefs: - description: |+ + description: |- ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means @@ -4779,10 +9932,15 @@ spec: generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - - - + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. items: description: |- ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered @@ -4845,6 +10003,16 @@ spec: generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + Support: Core maxLength: 63 @@ -4865,6 +10033,10 @@ spec: must match both specified values. + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly @@ -4919,34 +10091,35 @@ spec: maxItems: 32 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes + - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes 2 or more references to the same parent rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && - p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName - == '''')) : true))' - - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or - more references to the same parent + == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)): true))' + - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName - == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName - == p2.sectionName)))) + == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port + == p2.port)))) rules: default: - matches: - path: type: PathPrefix value: / - description: |+ - Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions. - + description: Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions. items: description: |- HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on @@ -4999,40 +10172,320 @@ spec: namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant documentation for details. - - When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD - honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. + When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD + honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. + + Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes + Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. + + If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the + backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the + protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. + + If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified + protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the + "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. + properties: + filters: + description: |- + Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the + request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. + + Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the + Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.) + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + cors: + description: |- + CORS defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + cross-origin request based on HTTP response header. + + Support: Extended + properties: + allowCredentials: + description: |- + AllowCredentials indicates whether the actual cross-origin request allows + to include credentials. + + The only valid value for the `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` response + header is true (case-sensitive). + + If the credentials are not allowed in cross-origin requests, the gateway + will omit the header `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` entirely rather + than setting its value to false. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - true + type: boolean + allowHeaders: + description: |- + AllowHeaders indicates which HTTP request headers are supported for + accessing the requested resource. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + When the `AllowHeaders` field is configured with one or more headers, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + which value is present in the `AllowHeaders` field. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` request header + is not included in the list of header names specified by the response + header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers`, it will present an error on the + client side. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + does not recognize by the client, it will also occur an error on the + client side. + + A wildcard indicates that the requests with all HTTP headers are allowed. + The `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowHeaders` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one or more + HTTP headers in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response + header. The value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` is same as + the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` header provided by the client. If + the header `Access-Control-Request-Headers` is not included in the + request, the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header, instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway + implementation may choose to add implementation-specific default headers. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: + + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" + + Invalid values include: + + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + allowMethods: + description: |- + AllowMethods indicates which HTTP methods are supported for accessing the + requested resource. + + Valid values are any method defined by RFC9110, along with the special + value `*`, which represents all HTTP methods are allowed. + + Method names are case sensitive, so these values are also case-sensitive. + (See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2616#section-5.1.1) + + Multiple method names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A CORS-safelisted method is a method that is `GET`, `HEAD`, or `POST`. + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-method) The + CORS-safelisted methods are always allowed, regardless of whether they + are specified in the `AllowMethods` field. + + When the `AllowMethods` field is configured with one or more methods, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header + which value is present in the `AllowMethods` field. + + If the HTTP method of the `Access-Control-Request-Method` request header + is not included in the list of methods specified by the response header + `Access-Control-Allow-Methods`, it will present an error on the client + side. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowMethods` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one HTTP method + in the value of the Access-Control-Allow-Methods response header. The + value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` is same as the + `Access-Control-Request-Method` header provided by the client. If the + header `Access-Control-Request-Method` is not included in the request, + the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway implementation may + choose to add implementation-specific default methods. + + Support: Extended + items: + enum: + - GET + - HEAD + - POST + - PUT + - DELETE + - CONNECT + - OPTIONS + - TRACE + - PATCH + - '*' + type: string + maxItems: 9 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: AllowMethods cannot contain '*' alongside + other methods + rule: '!(''*'' in self && self.size() > 1)' + allowOrigins: + description: |- + AllowOrigins indicates whether the response can be shared with requested + resource from the given `Origin`. + + The `Origin` consists of a scheme and a host, with an optional port, and + takes the form `://(:)`. + + Valid values for scheme are: `http` and `https`. + + Valid values for port are any integer between 1 and 65535 (the list of + available TCP/UDP ports). Note that, if not included, port `80` is + assumed for `http` scheme origins, and port `443` is assumed for `https` + origins. This may affect origin matching. + + The host part of the origin may contain the wildcard character `*`. These + wildcard characters behave as follows: + + * `*` is a greedy match to the _left_, including any number of + DNS labels to the left of its position. This also means that + `*` will include any number of period `.` characters to the + left of its position. + * A wildcard by itself matches all hosts. + + An origin value that includes _only_ the `*` character indicates requests + from all `Origin`s are allowed. + + When the `AllowOrigins` field is configured with multiple origins, it + means the server supports clients from multiple origins. If the request + `Origin` matches the configured allowed origins, the gateway must return + the given `Origin` and sets value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` same as the `Origin` header provided by the + client. + + The status code of a successful response to a "preflight" request is + always an OK status (i.e., 204 or 200). + + If the request `Origin` does not match the configured allowed origins, + the gateway returns 204/200 response but doesn't set the relevant + cross-origin response headers. Alternatively, the gateway responds with + 403 status to the "preflight" request is denied, coupled with omitting + the CORS headers. The cross-origin request fails on the client side. + Therefore, the client doesn't attempt the actual cross-origin request. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowOrigins` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must return a single origin + in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. The value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` is same as the `Origin` header provided by + the client. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + The AbsoluteURI MUST NOT be a relative URI, and it MUST follow the URI syntax and + encoding rules specified in RFC3986. The AbsoluteURI MUST include both a + scheme (e.g., "http" or "spiffe") and a scheme-specific-part. URIs that + include an authority MUST include a fully qualified domain name or + IP address as the host. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(([^:/?#]+):)(//([^/?#]*))([^?#]*)(\?([^#]*))?(#(.*))? + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + exposeHeaders: + description: |- + ExposeHeaders indicates which HTTP response headers can be exposed + to client-side scripts in response to a cross-origin request. + + A CORS-safelisted response header is an HTTP header in a CORS response + that it is considered safe to expose to the client scripts. + The CORS-safelisted response headers include the following headers: + `Cache-Control` + `Content-Language` + `Content-Length` + `Content-Type` + `Expires` + `Last-Modified` + `Pragma` + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-response-header-name) + The CORS-safelisted response headers are exposed to client by default. + + When an HTTP header name is specified using the `ExposeHeaders` field, + this additional header will be exposed as part of the response to the + client. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A wildcard indicates that the responses with all HTTP headers are exposed + to clients. The `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` response header can only + use `*` wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is + unspecified. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: - Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes - Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" - If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the - backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the - protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. + Invalid values include: - If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified - protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the - "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + maxAge: + default: 5 + description: |- + MaxAge indicates the duration (in seconds) for the client to cache the + results of a "preflight" request. - - properties: - filters: - description: |- - Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the - request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. + The information provided by the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` and + `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response headers can be cached by the + client until the time specified by `Access-Control-Max-Age` elapses. - Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the - Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.) - items: - description: |- - HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the - request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension - point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some - examples include request or response modification, implementing - authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API - guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. - properties: + The default value of `Access-Control-Max-Age` response header is 5 + (seconds). + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + type: object extensionRef: description: |- ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the @@ -5101,7 +10554,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -5176,7 +10629,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -5204,7 +10657,7 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-type: map type: object requestMirror: - description: |+ + description: |- RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from that destination are ignored. @@ -5214,7 +10667,6 @@ spec: backends. Support: Extended - properties: backendRef: description: |- @@ -5309,9 +10761,49 @@ spec: - message: Must have port for Service reference rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + fraction: + description: |- + Fraction represents the fraction of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + properties: + denominator: + default: 100 + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + numerator: + format: int32 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - numerator + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: numerator must be less than or equal + to denominator + rule: self.numerator <= self.denominator + percent: + description: |- + Percent represents the percentage of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. Its minimum value is 0 (indicating 0% of + requests) and its maximum value is 100 (indicating 100% of requests). + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + format: int32 + maximum: 100 + minimum: 0 + type: integer required: - backendRef type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Only one of percent or fraction may be + specified in HTTPRequestMirrorFilter + rule: '!(has(self.percent) && has(self.fraction))' requestRedirect: description: |- RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the @@ -5498,7 +10990,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -5573,7 +11065,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -5641,6 +11133,7 @@ spec: - RequestRedirect - URLRewrite - ExtensionRef + - CORS type: string urlRewrite: description: |- @@ -5773,6 +11266,11 @@ spec: - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef filter.type rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.cors must be nil if the filter.type + is not CORS + rule: '!(has(self.cors) && self.type != ''CORS'')' + - message: filter.cors must be specified for CORS filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.cors) && self.type == ''CORS'')' maxItems: 16 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: @@ -5894,7 +11392,7 @@ spec: they are specified. Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting - any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations + any combination or order of filters that cannot be supported. If implementations choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document that behavior. @@ -5916,7 +11414,7 @@ spec: All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an - implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly + implementation cannot support other combinations of filters, they must clearly document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify @@ -5932,6 +11430,289 @@ spec: authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. properties: + cors: + description: |- + CORS defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + cross-origin request based on HTTP response header. + + Support: Extended + properties: + allowCredentials: + description: |- + AllowCredentials indicates whether the actual cross-origin request allows + to include credentials. + + The only valid value for the `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` response + header is true (case-sensitive). + + If the credentials are not allowed in cross-origin requests, the gateway + will omit the header `Access-Control-Allow-Credentials` entirely rather + than setting its value to false. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - true + type: boolean + allowHeaders: + description: |- + AllowHeaders indicates which HTTP request headers are supported for + accessing the requested resource. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + When the `AllowHeaders` field is configured with one or more headers, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + which value is present in the `AllowHeaders` field. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` request header + is not included in the list of header names specified by the response + header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers`, it will present an error on the + client side. + + If any header name in the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header + does not recognize by the client, it will also occur an error on the + client side. + + A wildcard indicates that the requests with all HTTP headers are allowed. + The `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowHeaders` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one or more + HTTP headers in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response + header. The value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` is same as + the `Access-Control-Request-Headers` header provided by the client. If + the header `Access-Control-Request-Headers` is not included in the + request, the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` + response header, instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway + implementation may choose to add implementation-specific default headers. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: + + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" + + Invalid values include: + + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + allowMethods: + description: |- + AllowMethods indicates which HTTP methods are supported for accessing the + requested resource. + + Valid values are any method defined by RFC9110, along with the special + value `*`, which represents all HTTP methods are allowed. + + Method names are case sensitive, so these values are also case-sensitive. + (See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2616#section-5.1.1) + + Multiple method names in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A CORS-safelisted method is a method that is `GET`, `HEAD`, or `POST`. + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-method) The + CORS-safelisted methods are always allowed, regardless of whether they + are specified in the `AllowMethods` field. + + When the `AllowMethods` field is configured with one or more methods, the + gateway must return the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header + which value is present in the `AllowMethods` field. + + If the HTTP method of the `Access-Control-Request-Method` request header + is not included in the list of methods specified by the response header + `Access-Control-Allow-Methods`, it will present an error on the client + side. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowMethods` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must specify one HTTP method + in the value of the Access-Control-Allow-Methods response header. The + value of the header `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` is same as the + `Access-Control-Request-Method` header provided by the client. If the + header `Access-Control-Request-Method` is not included in the request, + the gateway will omit the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. A Gateway implementation may + choose to add implementation-specific default methods. + + Support: Extended + items: + enum: + - GET + - HEAD + - POST + - PUT + - DELETE + - CONNECT + - OPTIONS + - TRACE + - PATCH + - '*' + type: string + maxItems: 9 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: AllowMethods cannot contain '*' alongside + other methods + rule: '!(''*'' in self && self.size() > 1)' + allowOrigins: + description: |- + AllowOrigins indicates whether the response can be shared with requested + resource from the given `Origin`. + + The `Origin` consists of a scheme and a host, with an optional port, and + takes the form `://(:)`. + + Valid values for scheme are: `http` and `https`. + + Valid values for port are any integer between 1 and 65535 (the list of + available TCP/UDP ports). Note that, if not included, port `80` is + assumed for `http` scheme origins, and port `443` is assumed for `https` + origins. This may affect origin matching. + + The host part of the origin may contain the wildcard character `*`. These + wildcard characters behave as follows: + + * `*` is a greedy match to the _left_, including any number of + DNS labels to the left of its position. This also means that + `*` will include any number of period `.` characters to the + left of its position. + * A wildcard by itself matches all hosts. + + An origin value that includes _only_ the `*` character indicates requests + from all `Origin`s are allowed. + + When the `AllowOrigins` field is configured with multiple origins, it + means the server supports clients from multiple origins. If the request + `Origin` matches the configured allowed origins, the gateway must return + the given `Origin` and sets value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` same as the `Origin` header provided by the + client. + + The status code of a successful response to a "preflight" request is + always an OK status (i.e., 204 or 200). + + If the request `Origin` does not match the configured allowed origins, + the gateway returns 204/200 response but doesn't set the relevant + cross-origin response headers. Alternatively, the gateway responds with + 403 status to the "preflight" request is denied, coupled with omitting + the CORS headers. The cross-origin request fails on the client side. + Therefore, the client doesn't attempt the actual cross-origin request. + + The `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header can only use `*` + wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is unspecified. + + When the `AllowCredentials` field is specified and `AllowOrigins` field + specified with the `*` wildcard, the gateway must return a single origin + in the value of the `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` response header, + instead of specifying the `*` wildcard. The value of the header + `Access-Control-Allow-Origin` is same as the `Origin` header provided by + the client. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + The AbsoluteURI MUST NOT be a relative URI, and it MUST follow the URI syntax and + encoding rules specified in RFC3986. The AbsoluteURI MUST include both a + scheme (e.g., "http" or "spiffe") and a scheme-specific-part. URIs that + include an authority MUST include a fully qualified domain name or + IP address as the host. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(([^:/?#]+):)(//([^/?#]*))([^?#]*)(\?([^#]*))?(#(.*))? + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + exposeHeaders: + description: |- + ExposeHeaders indicates which HTTP response headers can be exposed + to client-side scripts in response to a cross-origin request. + + A CORS-safelisted response header is an HTTP header in a CORS response + that it is considered safe to expose to the client scripts. + The CORS-safelisted response headers include the following headers: + `Cache-Control` + `Content-Language` + `Content-Length` + `Content-Type` + `Expires` + `Last-Modified` + `Pragma` + (See https://fetch.spec.whatwg.org/#cors-safelisted-response-header-name) + The CORS-safelisted response headers are exposed to client by default. + + When an HTTP header name is specified using the `ExposeHeaders` field, + this additional header will be exposed as part of the response to the + client. + + Header names are not case sensitive. + + Multiple header names in the value of the `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` + response header are separated by a comma (","). + + A wildcard indicates that the responses with all HTTP headers are exposed + to clients. The `Access-Control-Expose-Headers` response header can only + use `*` wildcard as value when the `AllowCredentials` field is + unspecified. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderName is the name of an HTTP header. + + Valid values include: + + * "Authorization" + * "Set-Cookie" + + Invalid values include: + + - ":method" - ":" is an invalid character. This means that HTTP/2 pseudo + headers are not currently supported by this type. + - "/invalid" - "/ " is an invalid character + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + maxAge: + default: 5 + description: |- + MaxAge indicates the duration (in seconds) for the client to cache the + results of a "preflight" request. + + The information provided by the `Access-Control-Allow-Methods` and + `Access-Control-Allow-Headers` response headers can be cached by the + client until the time specified by `Access-Control-Max-Age` elapses. + + The default value of `Access-Control-Max-Age` response header is 5 + (seconds). + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + type: object extensionRef: description: |- ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the @@ -5999,7 +11780,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -6073,7 +11854,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -6101,7 +11882,7 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-type: map type: object requestMirror: - description: |+ + description: |- RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from that destination are ignored. @@ -6111,7 +11892,6 @@ spec: backends. Support: Extended - properties: backendRef: description: |- @@ -6206,9 +11986,49 @@ spec: - message: Must have port for Service reference rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + fraction: + description: |- + Fraction represents the fraction of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + properties: + denominator: + default: 100 + format: int32 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + numerator: + format: int32 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - numerator + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: numerator must be less than or equal to + denominator + rule: self.numerator <= self.denominator + percent: + description: |- + Percent represents the percentage of requests that should be + mirrored to BackendRef. Its minimum value is 0 (indicating 0% of + requests) and its maximum value is 100 (indicating 100% of requests). + + Only one of Fraction or Percent may be specified. If neither field + is specified, 100% of requests will be mirrored. + format: int32 + maximum: 100 + minimum: 0 + type: integer required: - backendRef type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Only one of percent or fraction may be specified + in HTTPRequestMirrorFilter + rule: '!(has(self.percent) && has(self.fraction))' requestRedirect: description: |- RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the @@ -6394,7 +12214,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -6468,7 +12288,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries @@ -6536,6 +12356,7 @@ spec: - RequestRedirect - URLRewrite - ExtensionRef + - CORS type: string urlRewrite: description: |- @@ -6665,6 +12486,11 @@ spec: - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef filter.type rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.cors must be nil if the filter.type is not + CORS + rule: '!(has(self.cors) && self.type != ''CORS'')' + - message: filter.cors must be specified for CORS filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.cors) && self.type == ''CORS'')' maxItems: 16 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: @@ -6768,7 +12594,7 @@ spec: name: description: |- Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + case-insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent @@ -6937,47 +12763,232 @@ spec: as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of the Gateway API. - Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard - themselves against potential differences in the implementations. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - type: - default: Exact - description: |- - Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter. + Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard + themselves against potential differences in the implementations. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter. + + Support: Extended (Exact) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + + Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific + conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other + dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's + documentation to determine the supported dialect. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP query param + to be matched. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the route rule. This name MUST be unique within a Route if it is set. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + retry: + description: |- + Retry defines the configuration for when to retry an HTTP request. + + Support: Extended + properties: + attempts: + description: |- + Attempts specifies the maximum number of times an individual request + from the gateway to a backend should be retried. + + If the maximum number of retries has been attempted without a successful + response from the backend, the Gateway MUST return an error. + + When this field is unspecified, the number of times to attempt to retry + a backend request is implementation-specific. + + Support: Extended + type: integer + backoff: + description: |- + Backoff specifies the minimum duration a Gateway should wait between + retry attempts and is represented in Gateway API Duration formatting. + + For example, setting the `rules[].retry.backoff` field to the value + `100ms` will cause a backend request to first be retried approximately + 100 milliseconds after timing out or receiving a response code configured + to be retryable. + + An implementation MAY use an exponential or alternative backoff strategy + for subsequent retry attempts, MAY cap the maximum backoff duration to + some amount greater than the specified minimum, and MAY add arbitrary + jitter to stagger requests, as long as unsuccessful backend requests are + not retried before the configured minimum duration. + + If a Request timeout (`rules[].timeouts.request`) is configured on the + route, the entire duration of the initial request and any retry attempts + MUST not exceed the Request timeout duration. If any retry attempts are + still in progress when the Request timeout duration has been reached, + these SHOULD be canceled if possible and the Gateway MUST immediately + return a timeout error. + + If a BackendRequest timeout (`rules[].timeouts.backendRequest`) is + configured on the route, any retry attempts which reach the configured + BackendRequest timeout duration without a response SHOULD be canceled if + possible and the Gateway should wait for at least the specified backoff + duration before attempting to retry the backend request again. + + If a BackendRequest timeout is _not_ configured on the route, retry + attempts MAY time out after an implementation default duration, or MAY + remain pending until a configured Request timeout or implementation + default duration for total request time is reached. + + When this field is unspecified, the time to wait between retry attempts + is implementation-specific. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + codes: + description: |- + Codes defines the HTTP response status codes for which a backend request + should be retried. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteRetryStatusCode defines an HTTP response status code for + which a backend request should be retried. + + Implementations MUST support the following status codes as retryable: + + * 500 + * 502 + * 503 + * 504 + + Implementations MAY support specifying additional discrete values in the + 500-599 range. + + Implementations MAY support specifying discrete values in the 400-499 range, + which are often inadvisable to retry. + maximum: 599 + minimum: 400 + type: integer + type: array + type: object + sessionPersistence: + description: |- + SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence + for the route rule. + + Support: Extended + properties: + absoluteTimeout: + description: |- + AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent + session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the + session becomes invalid. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + cookieConfig: + description: |- + CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific + to cookie-based session persistence. + + Support: Core + properties: + lifetimeType: + default: Session + description: |- + LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or + session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its + specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie + attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current + session ends. + + When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes + and is required. + + When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and + is optional. + + Defaults to "Session". + + Support: Core for "Session" type + + Support: Extended for "Permanent" type + enum: + - Permanent + - Session + type: string + type: object + idleTimeout: + description: |- + IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session. + Once the session has been idle for more than the specified + IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + sessionName: + description: |- + SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token + which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users + should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended + consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior. - Support: Extended (Exact) + Support: Implementation-specific + maxLength: 128 + type: string + type: + default: Cookie + description: |- + Type defines the type of session persistence such as through + the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session + persistence. - Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + Support: Core for "Cookie" type - Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific - conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other - dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's - documentation to determine the supported dialect. - enum: - - Exact - - RegularExpression - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP query param - to be matched. - maxLength: 1024 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - maxItems: 64 - type: array + Support: Extended for "Header" type + enum: + - Cookie + - Header + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType + is Permanent + rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig) || !has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) + || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)' timeouts: description: |- Timeouts defines the timeouts that can be configured for an HTTP request. @@ -7098,6 +13109,9 @@ spec: : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? self[12].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 13 ? self[13].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? self[14].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? self[15].matches.size() : 0) <= 128' + - message: Rule name must be unique within the route + rule: self.all(l1, !has(l1.name) || self.exists_one(l2, has(l2.name) + && l1.name == l2.name)) type: object status: description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute. @@ -7141,7 +13155,7 @@ spec: There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: - * The Route refers to a non-existent parent. + * The Route refers to a nonexistent parent. * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. items: @@ -7276,6 +13290,16 @@ spec: generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + Support: Core maxLength: 63 @@ -7296,6 +13320,10 @@ spec: must match both specified values. + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly @@ -7360,13 +13388,42 @@ spec: - spec type: object served: true - storage: true + storage: false subresources: status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_referencegrants.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: referencegrants.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: ReferenceGrant + listKind: ReferenceGrantList + plural: referencegrants + shortNames: + - refgrant + singular: referencegrant + scope: Namespaced + versions: - additionalPrinterColumns: - - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames - name: Hostnames - type: string - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp name: Age type: date @@ -7374,10 +13431,22 @@ spec: schema: openAPIV3Schema: description: |- - HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability - to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be - used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching - requests should be routed. + ReferenceGrant identifies kinds of resources in other namespaces that are + trusted to reference the specified kinds of resources in the same namespace + as the policy. + + Each ReferenceGrant can be used to represent a unique trust relationship. + Additional Reference Grants can be used to add to the set of trusted + sources of inbound references for the namespace they are defined within. + + All cross-namespace references in Gateway API (with the exception of cross-namespace + Gateway-route attachment) require a ReferenceGrant. + + ReferenceGrant is a form of runtime verification allowing users to assert + which cross-namespace object references are permitted. Implementations that + support ReferenceGrant MUST NOT permit cross-namespace references which have + no grant, and MUST respond to the removal of a grant by revoking the access + that the grant allowed. properties: apiVersion: description: |- @@ -7397,87 +13466,188 @@ spec: metadata: type: object spec: - description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute. + description: Spec defines the desired state of ReferenceGrant. properties: - hostnames: + from: description: |- - Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host - header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations - MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while - performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification - configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend. - - Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a - hostname with 2 notable exceptions: - - 1. IPs are not allowed. - 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard - label must appear by itself as the first label. - - If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there - must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be - attached to the Listener. For example: + From describes the trusted namespaces and kinds that can reference the + resources described in "To". Each entry in this list MUST be considered + to be an additional place that references can be valid from, or to put + this another way, entries MUST be combined using OR. - * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes - that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at - least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`. - * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes - that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least - one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example, - `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would - all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would - not match. + Support: Core + items: + description: ReferenceGrantFrom describes trusted namespaces and + kinds. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred. - Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted - as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match - both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support + additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core" + support level for this field. - If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any - HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be - ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the - HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, - `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match. + When used to permit a SecretObjectReference: - If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none - match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The - implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of - `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + * Gateway - In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g. - overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must - be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of: + When used to permit a BackendObjectReference: - * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname. - * Characters in a matching hostname. + * GRPCRoute + * HTTPRoute + * TCPRoute + * TLSRoute + * UDPRoute + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. - If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for - HTTPRouteMatches takes over. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - namespace + type: object + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + to: + description: |- + To describes the resources that may be referenced by the resources + described in "From". Each entry in this list MUST be considered to be an + additional place that references can be valid to, or to put this another + way, entries MUST be combined using OR. Support: Core items: description: |- - Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches - the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: - - 1. IPs are not allowed. - 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard - label must appear by itself as the first label. + ReferenceGrantTo describes what Kinds are allowed as targets of the + references. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred. - Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating - dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a - domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`). + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support + additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core" + support level for this field: - Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case - alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric - character. No other punctuation is allowed. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string + * Secret when used to permit a SecretObjectReference + * Service when used to permit a BackendObjectReference + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. When unspecified, this policy + refers to all resources of the specified Group and Kind in the local + namespace. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + type: object maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 type: array + required: + - from + - to + type: object + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_tcproutes.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: tcproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: TCPRoute + listKind: TCPRouteList + plural: tcproutes + singular: tcproute + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1alpha2 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + TCPRoute provides a way to route TCP requests. When combined with a Gateway + listener, it can be used to forward connections on the port specified by the + listener to a set of backends specified by the TCPRoute. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of TCPRoute. + properties: parentRefs: - description: |+ + description: |- ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means @@ -7530,10 +13700,15 @@ spec: generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - - - + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. items: description: |- ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered @@ -7596,6 +13771,16 @@ spec: generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + Support: Core maxLength: 63 @@ -7616,6 +13801,10 @@ spec: must match both specified values. + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly @@ -7670,69 +13859,41 @@ spec: maxItems: 32 type: array x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes + - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes 2 or more references to the same parent rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && - p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName - == '''')) : true))' - - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or - more references to the same parent + == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)): true))' + - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName - == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName - == p2.sectionName)))) + == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port + == p2.port)))) rules: - default: - - matches: - - path: - type: PathPrefix - value: / - description: |+ - Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions. - + description: Rules are a list of TCP matchers and actions. items: - description: |- - HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on - conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to - an API object (backendRefs). + description: TCPRouteRule is the configuration for a given rule. properties: backendRefs: description: |- BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be - sent. - - Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and - how many are invalid. - - If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters - specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST - receive a 500 status code. - - See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single - HTTPBackendRef invalid. - - When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for - requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If - multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of - requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend - MUST receive a 500 status code. - - For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is - invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may - choose how that 50 percent is determined. - - When a HTTPBackendRef refers to a Service that has no ready endpoints, - implementations SHOULD return a 503 for requests to that backend instead. - If an implementation chooses to do this, all of the above rules for 500 responses - MUST also apply for responses that return a 503. + sent. If unspecified or invalid (refers to a nonexistent resource or a + Service with no endpoints), the underlying implementation MUST actively + reject connection attempts to this backend. Connection rejections must + respect weight; if an invalid backend is requested to have 80% of + connections, then 80% of connections must be rejected instead. Support: Core for Kubernetes Service @@ -7740,17 +13901,17 @@ spec: Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource - Support for weight: Core + Support for weight: Extended items: description: |- - HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request. + BackendRef defines how a Route should forward a request to a Kubernetes + resource. Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant documentation for details. - When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. @@ -7766,787 +13927,810 @@ spec: protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. - + + Note that when the BackendTLSPolicy object is enabled by the implementation, + there are some extra rules about validity to consider here. See the fields + where this struct is used for more information about the exact behavior. properties: - filters: + group: + default: "" description: |- - Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the - request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". - Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the - Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.) - items: - description: |- - HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the - request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension - point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some - examples include request or response modification, implementing - authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API - guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. - properties: - extensionRef: - description: |- - ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the - "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group - "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and - extended filters. + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + weight: + default: 1 + description: |- + Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced + backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this + BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from + the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an + implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of + weights does not need to equal 100. + + If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100% + of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no + traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight + defaults to 1. + + Support for this field varies based on the context where used. + format: int32 + maximum: 1000000 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the route rule. This name MUST be unique within a Route if it is set. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + type: object + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Rule name must be unique within the route + rule: self.all(l1, !has(l1.name) || self.exists_one(l2, has(l2.name) + && l1.name == l2.name)) + required: + - rules + type: object + status: + description: Status defines the current state of TCPRoute. + properties: + parents: + description: |- + Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to + each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller + first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the + route or gateway is modified. + + Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation + of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API + can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are + responsible for. + + A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + items: + description: |- + RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Parent. + properties: + conditions: + description: |- + Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. + Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own + status conditions and listener status. - This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports + Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, + then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the + Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the + Gateway, and why. - Support: Implementation-specific - properties: - group: - description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". - When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: Kind is kind of the referent. For - example "HTTPRoute" or "Service". - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - name: - description: Name is the name of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - group - - kind - - name - type: object - requestHeaderModifier: - description: |- - RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request - headers. + A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's + rules is implemented by the Gateway. - Support: Core - properties: - add: - description: |- - Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request - before the action. It appends to any existing values associated - with the header name. + There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set + due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo + * The Route refers to a nonexistent parent. + * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. + * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. - Config: - add: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar,baz" + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo,bar,baz - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP - Header name and value as defined by RFC - 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP - Header to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - remove: - description: |- - Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The - value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header - names are case-insensitive (see - https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + parentRef: + description: |- + ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header1: foo - my-header2: bar - my-header3: baz + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. - Config: - remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header2: bar - items: - type: string - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-type: set - set: - description: |- - Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) - before the action. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. - Config: - set: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar" + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: bar - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP - Header name and value as defined by RFC - 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP - Header to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - requestMirror: - description: |+ - RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. - Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from - that destination are ignored. - This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that - not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple - backends. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - Support: Extended + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. - properties: - backendRef: - description: |- - BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. - Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint - within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present - within this BackendRef. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. - If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be - dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" - condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure - this backend in the underlying implementation. + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. - If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object - that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the - "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, - with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the - underlying implementation. - In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition - should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. - Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service - Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource - properties: - group: - default: "" - description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". - When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - default: Service - description: |- - Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example - "Service". + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. - Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live - outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in - terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see - CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT - support ExternalName Services. + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: - Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. - Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - name: - description: Name is the name of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - namespace: - description: |- - Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local - namespace is inferred. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. - Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, - a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that - namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant - documentation for details. + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - Support: Core - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ - type: string - port: - description: |- - Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. - Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this - case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. - For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent - resource or this field. - format: int32 - maximum: 65535 - minimum: 1 - type: integer - required: - - name - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Must have port for Service reference - rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind - == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' - required: - - backendRef - type: object - requestRedirect: - description: |- - RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the - request with an HTTP redirection. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + - parentRef + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + required: + - parents + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_tlsroutes.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: tlsroutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: TLSRoute + listKind: TLSRouteList + plural: tlsroutes + singular: tlsroute + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1alpha2 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + The TLSRoute resource is similar to TCPRoute, but can be configured + to match against TLS-specific metadata. This allows more flexibility + in matching streams for a given TLS listener. + + If you need to forward traffic to a single target for a TLS listener, you + could choose to use a TCPRoute with a TLS listener. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of TLSRoute. + properties: + hostnames: + description: |- + Hostnames defines a set of SNI names that should match against the + SNI attribute of TLS ClientHello message in TLS handshake. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed in SNI names per RFC 6066. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. + + If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and TLSRoute, there + must be at least one intersecting hostname for the TLSRoute to be + attached to the Listener. For example: + + * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches TLSRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at + least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`. + * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches TLSRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least + one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example, + `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other + hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match. - Support: Core - properties: - hostname: - description: |- - Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` - header in the response. - When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + If both the Listener and TLSRoute have specified hostnames, any + TLSRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be + ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the + TLSRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, + `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match. - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - path: - description: |- - Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. - The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When - empty, the request path is used as-is. + If both the Listener and TLSRoute have specified hostnames, and none + match with the criteria above, then the TLSRoute is not accepted. The + implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of + `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. - Support: Extended - properties: - replaceFullPath: - description: |- - ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path - of a request during a rewrite or redirect. - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - replacePrefixMatch: - description: |- - ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix - match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request - to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch - of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: - Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This - matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels - in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is - ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all - match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. - ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. - Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in - the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating + dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a + domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`). - Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - type: - description: |- - Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be - added in a future release of the API. + Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case + alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric + character. No other punctuation is allowed. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + parentRefs: + description: |- + ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants + to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to + allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means + the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and + namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same + namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support + and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is + not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to + create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the + Route. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - enum: - - ReplaceFullPath - - ReplacePrefixMatch - type: string - required: - - type - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: replaceFullPath must be specified - when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? - has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when - replaceFullPath is set - rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type - == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' - - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified - when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' - ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' - when replacePrefixMatch is set - rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type - == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' - port: - description: |- - Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` - header in the response. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the - following rules: + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. - * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known - port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 - and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a - well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. - * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway - Listener port. + ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that: - Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' - header in the following cases: + * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef + entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the + multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must + be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route. + * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used, + each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of + optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a + combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination. - * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via - the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. - * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via - the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + Some examples: - Support: Extended - format: int32 - maximum: 65535 - minimum: 1 - type: integer - scheme: - description: |- - Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in - the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the + same object must also set `sectionName`. + * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same + object must also set `port`. + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs + referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`. - Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, - refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. + It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may + be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may + choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the + case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be + merged. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific + rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example, + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - Support: Extended - enum: - - http - - https - type: string - statusCode: - default: 302 - description: |- - StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + items: + description: |- + ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered + a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources + with "Core" support: - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - Support: Core - enum: - - 301 - - 302 - type: integer - type: object - responseHeaderModifier: - description: |- - ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response - headers. + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. - Support: Extended - properties: - add: - description: |- - Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request - before the action. It appends to any existing values associated - with the header name. + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo - Config: - add: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar,baz" + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo,bar,baz - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP - Header name and value as defined by RFC - 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP - Header to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - remove: - description: |- - Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The - value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header - names are case-insensitive (see - https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header1: foo - my-header2: bar - my-header3: baz + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. - Config: - remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header2: bar - items: - type: string - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-type: set - set: - description: |- - Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) - before the action. - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. - Config: - set: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar" - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: bar - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP - Header name and value as defined by RFC - 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP - Header to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - type: - description: |- - Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, - types are classified into three conformance levels: + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by - "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All - implementations must support core filters. + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: - - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by - "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers - are encouraged to support extended filters. + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. - - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by - specific vendors. - In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple - implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core - conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters - is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to - "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. - Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to - extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter - MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by - that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)): true))' + - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port + == p2.port)))) + rules: + description: Rules are a list of TLS matchers and actions. + items: + description: TLSRouteRule is the configuration for a given rule. + properties: + backendRefs: + description: |- + BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be + sent. If unspecified or invalid (refers to a nonexistent resource or + a Service with no endpoints), the rule performs no forwarding; if no + filters are specified that would result in a response being sent, the + underlying implementation must actively reject request attempts to this + backend, by rejecting the connection or returning a 500 status code. + Request rejections must respect weight; if an invalid backend is + requested to have 80% of requests, then 80% of requests must be rejected + instead. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + Support: Core for Kubernetes Service - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - enum: - - RequestHeaderModifier - - ResponseHeaderModifier - - RequestMirror - - RequestRedirect - - URLRewrite - - ExtensionRef - type: string - urlRewrite: - description: |- - URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport - Support: Extended - properties: - hostname: - description: |- - Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during - forwarding. + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + + Support for weight: Extended + items: + description: |- + BackendRef defines how a Route should forward a request to a Kubernetes + resource. - Support: Extended - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - path: - description: |- - Path defines a path rewrite. + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a + ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. - Support: Extended - properties: - replaceFullPath: - description: |- - ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path - of a request during a rewrite or redirect. - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - replacePrefixMatch: - description: |- - ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix - match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request - to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch - of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". - Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This - matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels - in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is - ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all - match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD + honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. - ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. - Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in - the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes + Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. - Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - type: - description: |- - Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be - added in a future release of the API. + If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the + backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the + protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified + protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the + "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - enum: - - ReplaceFullPath - - ReplacePrefixMatch - type: string - required: - - type - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: replaceFullPath must be specified - when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? - has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when - replaceFullPath is set - rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type - == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' - - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified - when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' - ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' - when replacePrefixMatch is set - rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type - == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' - type: object - required: - - type - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil - if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier - rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type - != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified - for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type - == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil - if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier - rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type - != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified - for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type - == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type - is not RequestMirror - rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' - - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for - RequestMirror filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == - ''RequestMirror'')' - - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the - filter.type is not RequestRedirect - rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != - ''RequestRedirect'')' - - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified - for RequestRedirect filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == - ''RequestRedirect'')' - - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type - is not URLRewrite - rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' - - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite - filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' - - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type - is not ExtensionRef - rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' - - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for - ExtensionRef filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect - or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both - rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') - && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' - - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect - or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both - rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') - && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' - - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() - <= 1 - - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() - <= 1 - - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() - <= 1 - - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() - <= 1 + + Note that when the BackendTLSPolicy object is enabled by the implementation, + there are some extra rules about validity to consider here. See the fields + where this struct is used for more information about the exact behavior. + properties: group: default: "" description: |- @@ -8628,1273 +14812,1562 @@ spec: minimum: 0 type: integer required: - - name + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the route rule. This name MUST be unique within a Route if it is set. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + type: object + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Rule name must be unique within the route + rule: self.all(l1, !has(l1.name) || self.exists_one(l2, has(l2.name) + && l1.name == l2.name)) + required: + - rules + type: object + status: + description: Status defines the current state of TLSRoute. + properties: + parents: + description: |- + Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to + each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller + first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the + route or gateway is modified. + + Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation + of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API + can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are + responsible for. + + A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + items: + description: |- + RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Parent. + properties: + conditions: + description: |- + Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. + Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own + status conditions and listener status. + + If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports + Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, + then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the + Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the + Gateway, and why. + + A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's + rules is implemented by the Gateway. + + There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set + due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: + + * The Route refers to a nonexistent parent. + * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. + * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Must have port for Service reference - rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') - ? has(self.port) : true' - maxItems: 16 + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 type: array - filters: + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: description: |- - Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match - this rule. + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. - Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order - they are specified. + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". - Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting - any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations - choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document - that behavior. + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). - To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD - consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules - in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only - a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the - "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route. + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + parentRef: + description: |- + ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). - Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter: + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. - - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations. - - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters. - - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across - implementations. + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: - Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly - indicated in the filter. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the - URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an - implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly - document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported - filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status - `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify - this configuration error. + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. - Support: Core - items: - description: |- - HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the - request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension - point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some - examples include request or response modification, implementing - authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API - guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. - properties: - extensionRef: - description: |- - ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the - "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group - "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and - extended filters. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. - This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. - Support: Implementation-specific - properties: - group: - description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". - When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example - "HTTPRoute" or "Service". - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - name: - description: Name is the name of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - group - - kind - - name - type: object - requestHeaderModifier: - description: |- - RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request - headers. - Support: Core - properties: - add: - description: |- - Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request - before the action. It appends to any existing values associated - with the header name. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. - Config: - add: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar,baz" - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo,bar,baz - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header - name and value as defined by RFC 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP Header - to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - remove: - description: |- - Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The - value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header - names are case-insensitive (see - https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header1: foo - my-header2: bar - my-header3: baz - Config: - remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header2: bar - items: - type: string - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-type: set - set: - description: |- - Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) - before the action. - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: - Config: - set: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar" + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: bar - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header - name and value as defined by RFC 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP Header - to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - requestMirror: - description: |+ - RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. - Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from - that destination are ignored. + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that - not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple - backends. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + - parentRef + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + required: + - parents + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_udproutes.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: udproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: UDPRoute + listKind: UDPRouteList + plural: udproutes + singular: udproute + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1alpha2 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + UDPRoute provides a way to route UDP traffic. When combined with a Gateway + listener, it can be used to forward traffic on the port specified by the + listener to a set of backends specified by the UDPRoute. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of UDPRoute. + properties: + parentRefs: + description: |- + ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants + to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to + allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means + the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and + namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same + namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support + and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is + not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to + create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the + Route. - Support: Extended + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: - properties: - backendRef: - description: |- - BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint - within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present - within this BackendRef. + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. - If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be - dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" - condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure - this backend in the underlying implementation. + ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that: - If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object - that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the - "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, - with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the - underlying implementation. + * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef + entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the + multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must + be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route. + * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used, + each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of + optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a + combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination. - In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition - should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + Some examples: - Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the + same object must also set `sectionName`. + * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same + object must also set `port`. + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs + referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`. - Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource - properties: - group: - default: "" - description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". - When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - default: Service - description: |- - Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example - "Service". + It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may + be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may + choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the + case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be + merged. - Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific + rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example, + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. - ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live - outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in - terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see - CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT - support ExternalName Services. - Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - name: - description: Name is the name of the referent. - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - namespace: - description: |- - Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local - namespace is inferred. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + items: + description: |- + ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered + a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources + with "Core" support: - Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, - a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that - namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant - documentation for details. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - Support: Core - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ - type: string - port: - description: |- - Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. - Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this - case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. - For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent - resource or this field. - format: int32 - maximum: 65535 - minimum: 1 - type: integer - required: - - name - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: Must have port for Service reference - rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') - ? has(self.port) : true' - required: - - backendRef - type: object - requestRedirect: - description: |- - RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the - request with an HTTP redirection. + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. - Support: Core - properties: - hostname: - description: |- - Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` - header in the response. - When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - path: - description: |- - Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. - The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When - empty, the request path is used as-is. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. - Support: Extended - properties: - replaceFullPath: - description: |- - ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path - of a request during a rewrite or redirect. - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - replacePrefixMatch: - description: |- - ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix - match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request - to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch - of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: - Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This - matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels - in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is - ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all - match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. - Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in - the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. - Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - type: - description: |- - Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be - added in a future release of the API. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - enum: - - ReplaceFullPath - - ReplacePrefixMatch - type: string - required: - - type - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when - type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) - : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath - is set - rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == - ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' - - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when - type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) - : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when - replacePrefixMatch is set - rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type - == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' - port: - description: |- - Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` - header in the response. - If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the - following rules: + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known - port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 - and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a - well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. - * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway - Listener port. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. - Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' - header in the following cases: - * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via - the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. - * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via - the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. - Support: Extended - format: int32 - maximum: 65535 - minimum: 1 - type: integer - scheme: - description: |- - Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in - the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. - Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, - refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - Support: Extended - enum: - - http - - https - type: string - statusCode: - default: 302 - description: |- - StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. - Support: Core - enum: - - 301 - - 302 - type: integer - type: object - responseHeaderModifier: - description: |- - ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response - headers. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)): true))' + - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port) + || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port + == p2.port)))) + rules: + description: Rules are a list of UDP matchers and actions. + items: + description: UDPRouteRule is the configuration for a given rule. + properties: + backendRefs: + description: |- + BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be + sent. If unspecified or invalid (refers to a nonexistent resource or a + Service with no endpoints), the underlying implementation MUST actively + reject connection attempts to this backend. Packet drops must + respect weight; if an invalid backend is requested to have 80% of + the packets, then 80% of packets must be dropped instead. - Support: Extended - properties: - add: - description: |- - Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request - before the action. It appends to any existing values associated - with the header name. + Support: Core for Kubernetes Service - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo + Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport - Config: - add: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar,baz" + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo,bar,baz - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header - name and value as defined by RFC 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + Support for weight: Extended + items: + description: |- + BackendRef defines how a Route should forward a request to a Kubernetes + resource. - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP Header - to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - remove: - description: |- - Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The - value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header - names are case-insensitive (see - https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a + ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header1: foo - my-header2: bar - my-header3: baz - Config: - remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD + honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header2: bar - items: - type: string - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-type: set - set: - description: |- - Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) - before the action. + Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes + Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. - Input: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: foo + If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the + backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the + protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. - Config: - set: - - name: "my-header" - value: "bar" + If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified + protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the + "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. - Output: - GET /foo HTTP/1.1 - my-header: bar - items: - description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header - name and value as defined by RFC 7230. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with - an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries - with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP Header - to be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - type: + Note that when the BackendTLSPolicy object is enabled by the implementation, + there are some extra rules about validity to consider here. See the fields + where this struct is used for more information about the exact behavior. + properties: + group: + default: "" description: |- - Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, - types are classified into three conformance levels: - - - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by - "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All - implementations must support core filters. + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". - - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by - "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers - are encouraged to support extended filters. + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. - - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by - specific vendors. - In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple - implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core - conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters - is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to - "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. - Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to - extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) - If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter - MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by - that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - enum: - - RequestHeaderModifier - - ResponseHeaderModifier - - RequestMirror - - RequestRedirect - - URLRewrite - - ExtensionRef + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ type: string - urlRewrite: + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + weight: + default: 1 description: |- - URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced + backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this + BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from + the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an + implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of + weights does not need to equal 100. - Support: Extended - properties: - hostname: - description: |- - Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during - forwarding. + If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100% + of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no + traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight + defaults to 1. - Support: Extended - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - path: - description: |- - Path defines a path rewrite. + Support for this field varies based on the context where used. + format: int32 + maximum: 1000000 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the route rule. This name MUST be unique within a Route if it is set. - Support: Extended - properties: - replaceFullPath: - description: |- - ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path - of a request during a rewrite or redirect. - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - replacePrefixMatch: - description: |- - ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix - match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request - to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch - of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + type: object + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Rule name must be unique within the route + rule: self.all(l1, !has(l1.name) || self.exists_one(l2, has(l2.name) + && l1.name == l2.name)) + required: + - rules + type: object + status: + description: Status defines the current state of UDPRoute. + properties: + parents: + description: |- + Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to + each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller + first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the + route or gateway is modified. - Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This - matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels - in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is - ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all - match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation + of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API + can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are + responsible for. - ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. - Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in - the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + items: + description: |- + RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Parent. + properties: + conditions: + description: |- + Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. + Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own + status conditions and listener status. - Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - type: - description: |- - Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be - added in a future release of the API. + If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports + Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, + then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the + Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the + Gateway, and why. - Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations - must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's + rules is implemented by the Gateway. - Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the - Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a - Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. - enum: - - ReplaceFullPath - - ReplacePrefixMatch - type: string - required: - - type - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when - type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) - : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath - is set - rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == - ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' - - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when - type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' - rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) - : true' - - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when - replacePrefixMatch is set - rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type - == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' - type: object + There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set + due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: + + * The Route refers to a nonexistent parent. + * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. + * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status - type - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the - filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier - rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type != - ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified - for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type == - ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the - filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier - rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type != - ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified - for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type - == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' - - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type - is not RequestMirror - rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' - - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror - filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')' - - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type - is not RequestRedirect - rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')' - - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect - filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')' - - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type - is not URLRewrite - rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' - - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite - filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' - - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type - is not ExtensionRef - rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' - - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef - filter.type - rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' - maxItems: 16 + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 type: array - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect - or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both - rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') && - self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' - - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() - <= 1 - - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() - <= 1 - - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <= - 1 - - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated - rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1 - matches: - default: - - path: - type: PathPrefix - value: / + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: description: |- - Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming - HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched - if **any** one of the matches is satisfied. + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. - For example, take the following matches configuration: + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". - ``` - matches: - - path: - value: "/foo" - headers: - - name: "version" - value: "v2" - - path: - value: "/v2/foo" - ``` + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). - For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy - EITHER of the two conditions: + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + parentRef: + description: |- + ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). - - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2` - - path prefix of `/v2/foo` + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. - See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple - match conditions that should be ANDed together. + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: - If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix - path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every - HTTP request. + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) - Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes - MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on - ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be - given to the match having: + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. - * "Exact" path match. - * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters. - * Method match. - * Largest number of header matches. - * Largest number of query param matches. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. - Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific. + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. - If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be - determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties: - * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. - * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by - "{namespace}/{name}". + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. - If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted - to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above - criteria. + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. - When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the - parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned. - items: - description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to - match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types - are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true - only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\nFor example, the - match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts - with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\tpath:\n\t - \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t - \ value \"v1\"\n\n```" - properties: - headers: - description: |- - Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are - ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers - to select the route. - items: - description: |- - HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request - headers. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be - case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). - If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first - entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent - entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the - case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered - equivalent. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. - When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is - implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented. - Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC: - https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding - processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie". - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - type: - default: Exact - description: |- - Type specifies how to match against the value of the header. + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. - Support: Core (Exact) - Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. - Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific - conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects - of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to - determine the supported dialect. - enum: - - Exact - - RegularExpression - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to - be matched. - maxLength: 4096 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - method: - description: |- - Method specifies HTTP method matcher. - When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the - specified method. - Support: Extended - enum: - - GET - - HEAD - - POST - - PUT - - DELETE - - CONNECT - - OPTIONS - - TRACE - - PATCH - type: string - path: - default: - type: PathPrefix - value: / - description: |- - Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not - specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided. - properties: - type: - default: PathPrefix - description: |- - Type specifies how to match against the path Value. + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + - parentRef + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + required: + - parents + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.x-k8s.io_xbackendtrafficpolicies.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + labels: + gateway.networking.k8s.io/policy: Direct + name: xbackendtrafficpolicies.gateway.networking.x-k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.x-k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: XBackendTrafficPolicy + listKind: XBackendTrafficPolicyList + plural: xbackendtrafficpolicies + shortNames: + - xbtrafficpolicy + singular: xbackendtrafficpolicy + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1alpha1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + XBackendTrafficPolicy defines the configuration for how traffic to a + target backend should be handled. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of BackendTrafficPolicy. + properties: + retryConstraint: + description: |- + RetryConstraint defines the configuration for when to allow or prevent + further retries to a target backend, by dynamically calculating a 'retry + budget'. This budget is calculated based on the percentage of incoming + traffic composed of retries over a given time interval. Once the budget + is exceeded, additional retries will be rejected. + + For example, if the retry budget interval is 10 seconds, there have been + 1000 active requests in the past 10 seconds, and the allowed percentage + of requests that can be retried is 20% (the default), then 200 of those + requests may be composed of retries. Active requests will only be + considered for the duration of the interval when calculating the retry + budget. Retrying the same original request multiple times within the + retry budget interval will lead to each retry being counted towards + calculating the budget. + + Configuring a RetryConstraint in BackendTrafficPolicy is compatible with + HTTPRoute Retry settings for each HTTPRouteRule that targets the same + backend. While the HTTPRouteRule Retry stanza can specify whether a + request will be retried, and the number of retry attempts each client + may perform, RetryConstraint helps prevent cascading failures such as + retry storms during periods of consistent failures. + + After the retry budget has been exceeded, additional retries to the + backend MUST return a 503 response to the client. + + Additional configurations for defining a constraint on retries MAY be + defined in the future. - Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix) + Support: Extended + properties: + budget: + default: + interval: 10s + percent: 20 + description: Budget holds the details of the retry budget configuration. + properties: + interval: + default: 10s + description: |- + Interval defines the duration in which requests will be considered + for calculating the budget for retries. - Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) - enum: - - Exact - - PathPrefix - - RegularExpression - type: string - value: - default: / - description: Value of the HTTP path to match against. - maxLength: 1024 - type: string - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: value must be an absolute path and start with - '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'') - : true' - - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'') - : true' - - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'') - : true' - - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'') - : true' - - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'') - : true' - - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'') - : true' - - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'') - : true' - - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'') - : true' - - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact', - 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'') - : true' - - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix', - 'RegularExpression'] - rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type - == 'RegularExpression' - - message: must only contain valid characters (matching - ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$) - for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] - rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""") - : true' - queryParams: - description: |- - QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match - values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the - specified query parameters to select the route. + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: interval can not be greater than one hour or less + than one second + rule: '!(duration(self) < duration(''1s'') || duration(self) + > duration(''1h''))' + percent: + default: 20 + description: |- + Percent defines the maximum percentage of active requests that may + be made up of retries. - Support: Extended - items: - description: |- - HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP - query parameters. - properties: - name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an - exact string match. (See - https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3). + Support: Extended + maximum: 100 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + type: object + minRetryRate: + default: + count: 10 + interval: 1s + description: |- + MinRetryRate defines the minimum rate of retries that will be allowable + over a specified duration of time. - If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first - entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent - entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored. + The effective overall minimum rate of retries targeting the backend + service may be much higher, as there can be any number of clients which + are applying this setting locally. - If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is - purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different - capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should - match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it, - as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of - the Gateway API. + This ensures that requests can still be retried during periods of low + traffic, where the budget for retries may be calculated as a very low + value. - Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard - themselves against potential differences in the implementations. - maxLength: 256 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ - type: string - type: - default: Exact - description: |- - Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter. + Support: Extended + properties: + count: + description: |- + Count specifies the number of requests per time interval. - Support: Extended (Exact) + Support: Extended + maximum: 1000000 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + interval: + description: |- + Interval specifies the divisor of the rate of requests, the amount of + time during which the given count of requests occur. - Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: interval can not be greater than one hour + rule: '!(duration(self) == duration(''0s'') || duration(self) + > duration(''1h''))' + type: object + type: object + sessionPersistence: + description: |- + SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence + for the backend. - Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific - conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other - dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's - documentation to determine the supported dialect. - enum: - - Exact - - RegularExpression - type: string - value: - description: Value is the value of HTTP query param - to be matched. - maxLength: 1024 - minLength: 1 - type: string - required: - - name - - value - type: object - maxItems: 16 - type: array - x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: - - name - x-kubernetes-list-type: map - type: object - maxItems: 64 - type: array - timeouts: - description: |- - Timeouts defines the timeouts that can be configured for an HTTP request. + Support: Extended + properties: + absoluteTimeout: + description: |- + AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent + session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the + session becomes invalid. - Support: Extended - properties: - backendRequest: - description: |- - BackendRequest specifies a timeout for an individual request from the gateway - to a backend. This covers the time from when the request first starts being - sent from the gateway to when the full response has been received from the backend. + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + cookieConfig: + description: |- + CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific + to cookie-based session persistence. + + Support: Core + properties: + lifetimeType: + default: Session + description: |- + LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or + session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its + specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie + attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current + session ends. - Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout - completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST - instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which - the timeout can be set. + When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes + and is required. - An entire client HTTP transaction with a gateway, covered by the Request timeout, - may result in more than one call from the gateway to the destination backend, - for example, if automatic retries are supported. + When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the + absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and + is optional. - The value of BackendRequest must be a Gateway API Duration string as defined by - GEP-2257. When this field is unspecified, its behavior is implementation-specific; - when specified, the value of BackendRequest must be no more than the value of the - Request timeout (since the Request timeout encompasses the BackendRequest timeout). + Defaults to "Session". - Support: Extended - pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ - type: string - request: - description: |- - Request specifies the maximum duration for a gateway to respond to an HTTP request. - If the gateway has not been able to respond before this deadline is met, the gateway - MUST return a timeout error. + Support: Core for "Session" type - For example, setting the `rules.timeouts.request` field to the value `10s` in an - `HTTPRoute` will cause a timeout if a client request is taking longer than 10 seconds - to complete. + Support: Extended for "Permanent" type + enum: + - Permanent + - Session + type: string + type: object + idleTimeout: + description: |- + IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session. + Once the session has been idle for more than the specified + IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid. - Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout - completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST - instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which - the timeout can be set. + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + sessionName: + description: |- + SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token + which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users + should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended + consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior. - This timeout is intended to cover as close to the whole request-response transaction - as possible although an implementation MAY choose to start the timeout after the entire - request stream has been received instead of immediately after the transaction is - initiated by the client. + Support: Implementation-specific + maxLength: 128 + type: string + type: + default: Cookie + description: |- + Type defines the type of session persistence such as through + the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session + persistence. - The value of Request is a Gateway API Duration string as defined by GEP-2257. When this - field is unspecified, request timeout behavior is implementation-specific. + Support: Core for "Cookie" type - Support: Extended - pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ - type: string - type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: backendRequest timeout cannot be longer than request - timeout - rule: '!(has(self.request) && has(self.backendRequest) && - duration(self.request) != duration(''0s'') && duration(self.backendRequest) - > duration(self.request))' + Support: Extended for "Header" type + enum: + - Cookie + - Header + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType + is Permanent + rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig) || !has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) + || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)' + targetRefs: + description: |- + TargetRefs identifies API object(s) to apply this policy to. + Currently, Backends (A grouping of like endpoints such as Service, + ServiceImport, or any implementation-specific backendRef) are the only + valid API target references. + + Currently, a TargetRef can not be scoped to a specific port on a + Service. + items: + description: |- + LocalPolicyTargetReference identifies an API object to apply a direct or + inherited policy to. This should be used as part of Policy resources + that can target Gateway API resources. For more information on how this + policy attachment model works, and a sample Policy resource, refer to + the policy attachment documentation for Gateway API. + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the target resource. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the target resource. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the target resource. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name type: object - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with - backendRefs - rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ? - (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))): - true' - - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, - exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified - rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) - && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type - == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) - ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || - self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) - : true' - - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, - exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified - rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) - && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' - && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches) - != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type - != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' - - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter - with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must - be specified - rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, - (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) - && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type - == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) - )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) - || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) - : true' - - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with - path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be - specified - rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, - (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) - && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' - && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches) - != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type - != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 type: array - x-kubernetes-validations: - - message: While 16 rules and 64 matches per rule are allowed, the - total number of matches across all rules in a route must be less - than 128 - rule: '(self.size() > 0 ? self[0].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() - > 1 ? self[1].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 2 ? self[2].matches.size() - : 0) + (self.size() > 3 ? self[3].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() - > 4 ? self[4].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 5 ? self[5].matches.size() - : 0) + (self.size() > 6 ? self[6].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() - > 7 ? self[7].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 8 ? self[8].matches.size() - : 0) + (self.size() > 9 ? self[9].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() - > 10 ? self[10].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 11 ? self[11].matches.size() - : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? self[12].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() - > 13 ? self[13].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? self[14].matches.size() - : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? self[15].matches.size() : 0) <= 128' + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - group + - kind + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + required: + - targetRefs type: object status: - description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute. + description: Status defines the current state of BackendTrafficPolicy. properties: - parents: + ancestors: description: |- - Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are - associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to - each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that - manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller - first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the - route or gateway is modified. - - Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation - of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API - can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are - responsible for. - - A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list - means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + Ancestors is a list of ancestor resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the policy, and the status of the policy with respect to + each ancestor. When this policy attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent and the ancestors MUST add an entry to this list when + the controller first sees the policy and SHOULD update the entry as + appropriate when the relevant ancestor is modified. + + Note that choosing the relevant ancestor is left to the Policy designers; + an important part of Policy design is designing the right object level at + which to namespace this status. + + Note also that implementations MUST ONLY populate ancestor status for + the Ancestor resources they are responsible for. Implementations MUST + use the ControllerName field to uniquely identify the entries in this list + that they are responsible for. + + Note that to achieve this, the list of PolicyAncestorStatus structs + MUST be treated as a map with a composite key, made up of the AncestorRef + and ControllerName fields combined. + + A maximum of 16 ancestors will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the Policy is not relevant for any ancestors. + + If this slice is full, implementations MUST NOT add further entries. + Instead they MUST consider the policy unimplementable and signal that + on any related resources such as the ancestor that would be referenced + here. For example, if this list was full on BackendTLSPolicy, no + additional Gateways would be able to reference the Service targeted by + the BackendTLSPolicy. items: description: |- - RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an - associated Parent. + PolicyAncestorStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Ancestor. + + Ancestors refer to objects that are either the Target of a policy or above it + in terms of object hierarchy. For example, if a policy targets a Service, the + Policy's Ancestors are, in order, the Service, the HTTPRoute, the Gateway, and + the GatewayClass. Almost always, in this hierarchy, the Gateway will be the most + useful object to place Policy status on, so we recommend that implementations + SHOULD use Gateway as the PolicyAncestorStatus object unless the designers + have a _very_ good reason otherwise. + + In the context of policy attachment, the Ancestor is used to distinguish which + resource results in a distinct application of this policy. For example, if a policy + targets a Service, it may have a distinct result per attached Gateway. + + Policies targeting the same resource may have different effects depending on the + ancestors of those resources. For example, different Gateways targeting the same + Service may have different capabilities, especially if they have different underlying + implementations. + + For example, in BackendTLSPolicy, the Policy attaches to a Service that is + used as a backend in a HTTPRoute that is itself attached to a Gateway. + In this case, the relevant object for status is the Gateway, and that is the + ancestor object referred to in this status. + + Note that a parent is also an ancestor, so for objects where the parent is the + relevant object for status, this struct SHOULD still be used. + + This struct is intended to be used in a slice that's effectively a map, + with a composite key made up of the AncestorRef and the ControllerName. properties: - conditions: + ancestorRef: description: |- - Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. - Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own - status conditions and listener status. + AncestorRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + PolicyAncestorStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). - If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports - Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, - then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the - Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the - Gateway, and why. + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer" + routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from + any namespace to the Service. + + ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are + "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound + connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which + the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a + ParentRef of the Route. + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the + Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified, + the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values. + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: - A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's - rules is implemented by the Gateway. + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. - There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set - due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. - * The Route refers to a non-existent parent. - * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. - * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + conditions: + description: Conditions describes the status of the Policy with + respect to the given Ancestor. items: description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current state of this API Resource. @@ -9958,352 +16431,885 @@ spec: x-kubernetes-list-type: map controllerName: description: |- - ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the - controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the - controllerName field on GatewayClass. + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. + + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). + + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + required: + - ancestorRef + - controllerName + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + required: + - ancestors + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.x-k8s.io_xlistenersets.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.3.0 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental + creationTimestamp: null + name: xlistenersets.gateway.networking.x-k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.x-k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: XListenerSet + listKind: XListenerSetList + plural: xlistenersets + shortNames: + - lset + singular: xlistenerset + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status + name: Accepted + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status + name: Programmed + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1alpha1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + XListenerSet defines a set of additional listeners + to attach to an existing Gateway. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of ListenerSet. + properties: + listeners: + description: |- + Listeners associated with this ListenerSet. Listeners define + logical endpoints that are bound on this referenced parent Gateway's addresses. + + Listeners in a `Gateway` and their attached `ListenerSets` are concatenated + as a list when programming the underlying infrastructure. Each listener + name does not need to be unique across the Gateway and ListenerSets. + See ListenerEntry.Name for more details. + + Implementations MUST treat the parent Gateway as having the merged + list of all listeners from itself and attached ListenerSets using + the following precedence: + + 1. "parent" Gateway + 2. ListenerSet ordered by creation time (oldest first) + 3. ListenerSet ordered alphabetically by “{namespace}/{name}”. + + An implementation MAY reject listeners by setting the ListenerEntryStatus + `Accepted`` condition to False with the Reason `TooManyListeners` + + If a listener has a conflict, this will be reported in the + Status.ListenerEntryStatus setting the `Conflicted` condition to True. + + Implementations SHOULD be cautious about what information from the + parent or siblings are reported to avoid accidentally leaking + sensitive information that the child would not otherwise have access + to. This can include contents of secrets etc. + items: + properties: + allowedRoutes: + default: + namespaces: + from: Same + description: |- + AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a + Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be + present. + + Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule + may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria: + + * The most specific match as defined by the Route type. + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with + a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over + a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04". + * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in + alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For + example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz. + + All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be + implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean + the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid, + support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For + example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest + of the rules within that Route should still be supported. + properties: + kinds: + description: |- + Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind + to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes + selected are determined using the Listener protocol. + + A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible + with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field. + If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it + MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the + "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. + + Support: Core + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind + of a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + namespaces: + default: + from: Same + description: |- + Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this + Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default. + + Support: Core + properties: + from: + default: Same + description: |- + From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible + values are: + + * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway. + * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by + this Gateway. + * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway. + + Support: Core + enum: + - All + - Selector + - Same + type: string + selector: + description: |- + Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case, + only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this + Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From". + + Support: Core + properties: + matchExpressions: + description: matchExpressions is a list of label + selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed. + items: + description: |- + A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that + relates the key and values. + properties: + key: + description: key is the label key that the + selector applies to. + type: string + operator: + description: |- + operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values. + Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist. + type: string + values: + description: |- + values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn, + the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist, + the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic + merge patch. + items: + type: string + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + required: + - key + - operator + type: object + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + matchLabels: + additionalProperties: + type: string + description: |- + matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels + map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the + operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed. + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic + type: object + type: object + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that + define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This + field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based + matching. - Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of + the following protocols: - The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are - valid Kubernetes names - (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). + * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI. + * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request. + * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP + protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not + ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname, + it MUST clearly document that. - Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that - entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no - longer necessary. + For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the + `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames, + there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be + accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames + documentation. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. maxLength: 253 minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ type: string - parentRef: + name: description: |- - ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this - RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. - properties: - group: - default: gateway.networking.k8s.io - description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. - When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. - To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), - Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). - - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - default: Gateway - description: |- - Kind is kind of the referent. + Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a + ListenerSet. - There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + Name is not required to be unique across a Gateway and ListenerSets. + Routes can attach to a Listener by having a ListenerSet as a parentRef + and setting the SectionName + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the + same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + protocol: + description: Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener + expects to receive. + maxLength: 255 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$ + type: string + tls: + description: |- + TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if + the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field + if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP". - * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) - * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is + defined based on the Hostname field for this listener. - Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string - name: + The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all + available certificates for any TLS handshake. + properties: + certificateRefs: description: |- - Name is the name of the referent. + CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that + contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to + establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the + associated listener. - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - type: string - namespace: - description: |- - Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers - to the local namespace of the Route. + A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to + a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. - Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace - boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly - allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: - Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a - generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set + to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise. + CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e. + Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources. - Support: Core - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ - type: string - port: - description: |- - Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted - differently based on the type of parent resource. + Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls - When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners - listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and - select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the - networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port - as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port - and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener - must match both specified values. + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types) + items: + description: |- + SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace, + defaulting to Secret. + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Secret + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "Secret". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. - Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. - Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly - document how/if Port is interpreted. + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. - For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as - long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway - listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, - namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment - from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully - attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, - the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + frontendValidation: + description: |- + FrontendValidation holds configuration information for validating the frontend (client). + Setting this field will require clients to send a client certificate + required for validation during the TLS handshake. In browsers this may result in a dialog appearing + that requests a user to specify the client certificate. + The maximum depth of a certificate chain accepted in verification is Implementation specific. Support: Extended - format: int32 - maximum: 65535 - minimum: 1 - type: integer - sectionName: - description: |- - SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the - following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + properties: + caCertificateRefs: + description: |- + CACertificateRefs contains one or more references to + Kubernetes objects that contain TLS certificates of + the Certificate Authorities that can be used + as a trust anchor to validate the certificates presented by the client. + + A single CA certificate reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap + has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple CA certificates to + a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + + Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap + with the CA certificate in a key named `ca.crt`. + + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference, or other kinds + of resources). + + References to a resource in a different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + items: + description: |- + ObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace. - * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName - are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match - both specified values. - * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName - are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match - both specified values. + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When set to the empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For + example "ConfigMap" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. - Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. - If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is - interpreted. + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + type: object + mode: + default: Terminate + description: |- + Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client. + There are two possible modes: - When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. - For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at - least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway - listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, - namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from - the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully - attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the - Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the + Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates + to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs + field. + - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This + implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for + the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field + is ignored in this mode. Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + enum: + - Terminate + - Passthrough type: string - required: - - name + options: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS + configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the + minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites. + + A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid + any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use + domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`. + Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API. + + Support: Implementation-specific + maxProperties: 16 + type: object type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when + mode is Terminate + rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs) + > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true' required: - - controllerName - - parentRef + - name + - port + - protocol type: object - maxItems: 32 + maxItems: 64 + minItems: 1 type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP', + 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? + !has(l.tls) : true)' + - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS + rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode + == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)' + - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname) + || l.hostname == '''') : true)' + - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway + rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name)) + - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique + for each listener + rule: 'self.all(l1, !has(l1.port) || self.exists_one(l2, has(l2.port) + && l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) + && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) + && !has(l2.hostname))))' + parentRef: + description: ParentRef references the Gateway that the listeners are + attached to. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example "Gateway". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. If not present, + the namespace of the referent is assumed to be the same as + the namespace of the referring object. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object required: - - parents - type: object - required: - - spec - type: object - served: true - storage: false - subresources: - status: {} -status: - acceptedNames: - kind: "" - plural: "" - conditions: null - storedVersions: null ---- -apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 -kind: CustomResourceDefinition -metadata: - annotations: - api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.0 - gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard - creationTimestamp: null - name: referencegrants.gateway.networking.k8s.io -spec: - group: gateway.networking.k8s.io - names: - categories: - - gateway-api - kind: ReferenceGrant - listKind: ReferenceGrantList - plural: referencegrants - shortNames: - - refgrant - singular: referencegrant - scope: Namespaced - versions: - - additionalPrinterColumns: - - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp - name: Age - type: date - name: v1beta1 - schema: - openAPIV3Schema: - description: |- - ReferenceGrant identifies kinds of resources in other namespaces that are - trusted to reference the specified kinds of resources in the same namespace - as the policy. - - Each ReferenceGrant can be used to represent a unique trust relationship. - Additional Reference Grants can be used to add to the set of trusted - sources of inbound references for the namespace they are defined within. - - All cross-namespace references in Gateway API (with the exception of cross-namespace - Gateway-route attachment) require a ReferenceGrant. - - ReferenceGrant is a form of runtime verification allowing users to assert - which cross-namespace object references are permitted. Implementations that - support ReferenceGrant MUST NOT permit cross-namespace references which have - no grant, and MUST respond to the removal of a grant by revoking the access - that the grant allowed. - properties: - apiVersion: - description: |- - APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. - Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and - may reject unrecognized values. - More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources - type: string - kind: - description: |- - Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. - Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. - Cannot be updated. - In CamelCase. - More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds - type: string - metadata: + - listeners + - parentRef type: object - spec: - description: Spec defines the desired state of ReferenceGrant. + status: + default: + conditions: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed + description: Status defines the current state of ListenerSet. properties: - from: + conditions: + default: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed description: |- - From describes the trusted namespaces and kinds that can reference the - resources described in "To". Each entry in this list MUST be considered - to be an additional place that references can be valid from, or to put - this another way, entries MUST be combined using OR. - - Support: Core - items: - description: ReferenceGrantFrom describes trusted namespaces and - kinds. - properties: - group: - description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. - When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred. - - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: |- - Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support - additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core" - support level for this field. - - When used to permit a SecretObjectReference: + Conditions describe the current conditions of the ListenerSet. - * Gateway + Implementations MUST express ListenerSet conditions using the + `ListenerSetConditionType` and `ListenerSetConditionReason` + constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common + vocabulary to describe ListenerSet state. - When used to permit a BackendObjectReference: + Known condition types are: - * GRPCRoute - * HTTPRoute - * TCPRoute - * TLSRoute - * UDPRoute - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + * "Accepted" + * "Programmed" + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current + state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time type: string - namespace: + message: description: |- - Namespace is the namespace of the referent. - - Support: Core - maxLength: 63 + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ type: string required: - - group - - kind - - namespace + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type type: object - maxItems: 16 - minItems: 1 + maxItems: 8 type: array - to: - description: |- - To describes the resources that may be referenced by the resources - described in "From". Each entry in this list MUST be considered to be an - additional place that references can be valid to, or to put this another - way, entries MUST be combined using OR. - - Support: Core + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + listeners: + description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port + defined in the Spec. items: - description: |- - ReferenceGrantTo describes what Kinds are allowed as targets of the - references. + description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener. properties: - group: + attachedRoutes: description: |- - Group is the group of the referent. - When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred. + AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been + successfully attached to this Listener. - Support: Core - maxLength: 253 - pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ - type: string - kind: - description: |- - Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support - additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core" - support level for this field: + Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the + combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener + and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to + a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field + AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway + resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on + attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various + Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact + successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set + for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully + attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions. - * Secret when used to permit a SecretObjectReference - * Service when used to permit a BackendObjectReference - maxLength: 63 - minLength: 1 - pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ - type: string + Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and + measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener. + format: int32 + type: integer + conditions: + description: Conditions describe the current condition of this + listener. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map name: - description: |- - Name is the name of the referent. When unspecified, this policy - refers to all resources of the specified Group and Kind in the local - namespace. + description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status + corresponds to. maxLength: 253 minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ type: string + port: + description: Port is the network port the listener is configured + to listen on. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + supportedKinds: + description: |- + SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this + listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for + that Listener configuration. + + If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT + appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" + condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid + and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST + reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified. + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of + a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array required: - - group - - kind + - attachedRoutes + - conditions + - name + - port + - supportedKinds type: object - maxItems: 16 - minItems: 1 + maxItems: 64 type: array - required: - - from - - to + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map type: object + required: + - spec type: object served: true storage: true - subresources: {} + subresources: + status: {} status: acceptedNames: kind: ""